blob: b516adde6dc1333ae57327913b1cf0eed9eb3519 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau73dec762021-11-23 15:50:11 +01005 version 2.6
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau2454d6e2022-02-01 18:06:59 +01007 2022/02/01
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020025 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100341.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100371.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100442.4. Conditional blocks
452.5. Time format
462.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020047
483. Global parameters
493.1. Process management and security
503.2. Performance tuning
513.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100523.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200533.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200543.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200553.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100563.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200573.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100583.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020059
604. Proxies
614.1. Proxy keywords matrix
624.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
63
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100645. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200655.1. Bind options
665.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200675.3. Server DNS resolution
685.3.1. Global overview
695.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020070
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100716. Cache
726.1. Limitation
736.2. Setup
746.2.1. Cache section
756.2.2. Proxy section
76
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200777. Using ACLs and fetching samples
787.1. ACL basics
797.1.1. Matching booleans
807.1.2. Matching integers
817.1.3. Matching strings
827.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
837.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
847.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
857.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
867.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200877.3.1. Converters
887.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
897.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
907.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
917.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
927.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200937.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200947.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020095
968. Logging
978.1. Log levels
988.2. Log formats
998.2.1. Default log format
1008.2.2. TCP log format
1018.2.3. HTTP log format
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02001028.2.4. HTTPS log format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01001038.2.5. Error log format
1048.2.6. Custom log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001058.3. Advanced logging options
1068.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1078.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1088.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1098.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1108.4. Timing events
1118.5. Session state at disconnection
1128.6. Non-printable characters
1138.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1148.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1158.9. Examples of logs
116
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001179. Supported filters
1189.1. Trace
1199.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001209.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001219.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001229.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001239.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200124
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012510. FastCGI applications
12610.1. Setup
12710.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12810.1.2. Proxy section
12910.1.3. Example
13010.2. Default parameters
13110.3. Limitations
132
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013311. Address formats
13411.1. Address family prefixes
13511.2. Socket type prefixes
13611.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200137
1381. Quick reminder about HTTP
139----------------------------
140
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100141When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200142fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
143on almost anything found in the contents.
144
145However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
146formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
147correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
148
149
1501.1. The HTTP transaction model
151-------------------------------
152
153The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100154to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100155from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
156connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157will involve a new connection :
158
159 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
160
161In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
162establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
163by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
164length.
165
166Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
167to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
168however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
169response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
170header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
171
172 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
173
174Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
175power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
176but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200177a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100179Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200180keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
181second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
182page :
183
184 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
185
186This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
187latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
188correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
189the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100190server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200191
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100192The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
193time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
194are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
195parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
196carry the stream identifier.
197
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100198By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
199connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
200leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100201start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
202processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
203waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200204
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200205HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100206 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
207 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100208 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200210 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100211
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100212
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213
2141.2. HTTP request
215-----------------
216
217First, let's consider this HTTP request :
218
219 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100220 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200221 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
222 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
223 3 User-agent: my small browser
224 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
225 5 Accept: image/png
226
227
2281.2.1. The Request line
229-----------------------
230
231Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
232
233 - a METHOD : GET
234 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
235 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
236
237All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
238which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
239followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
240is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
241desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
242the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
243
244The URI itself can have several forms :
245
246 - A "relative URI" :
247
248 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
249
250 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
251 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
252
253 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
254
255 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
256
257 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
258 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
259 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
260 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
261 must accept this form too.
262
263 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
264 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
265 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100266
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200267 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
268 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
269 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
270 other protocols too.
271
272In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
273mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
274on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
275It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
276specific to the language, framework or application in use.
277
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100279assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100280
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200281
2821.2.2. The request headers
283--------------------------
284
285The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
286beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
287an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
288Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
289values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
290encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
291the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
292define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
293
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100294Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200295their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100296"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200297as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
298normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
299representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
300HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200301
302The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
303that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
304is one valid form of empty line.
305
306Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
307headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
308about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
309application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
310
311Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000312 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200313 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
314 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
315 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
316
317
3181.3. HTTP response
319------------------
320
321An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
322messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
323
324 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100325 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200326 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
327 2 Content-length: 350
328 3 Content-Type: text/html
329
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200330As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
331codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
332response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100333continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
334the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
335following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
336sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
337(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
338correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
339such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
340state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400341over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100342if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
343information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003461.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200347------------------------
348
349Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
350
351 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
352 - a status code : 200
353 - a reason : OK
354
355The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100356 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
357 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
358 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
359 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
360 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200361
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000362Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100363"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200364found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
365messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
366or "Authentication Required".
367
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100368HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200369
370 Code When / reason
371 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
372 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
373 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100375 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
376 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200377 400 for an invalid or too large request
378 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
379 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200380 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100381 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200382 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100383 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
384 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200386 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400387 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100388 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200390 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200391 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
392 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
393 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
394
395The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3964.2).
397
398
3991.3.2. The response headers
400---------------------------
401
402Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
403the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
404details.
405
406
4072. Configuring HAProxy
408----------------------
409
4102.1. Configuration file format
411------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200412
413HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
414
415 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700417 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200419
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100420The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
421a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100422
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100423 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
424
425 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
426
427 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
428 tab characters
429
430 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
431 keyword sequences listed in this document
432
433 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
434 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
435 parts of the configuration, or expressions
436
437 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
438 are supported
439
440 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
441 section
442
443This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
444generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
445figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
446
447First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
448the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
449a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
450word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
451follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
452the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
453the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
454the parts that need to be addressed.
455
456A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
457requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
458extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
459the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
460section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
461section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
462not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
463
464A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
465each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
466a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
467start a new one.
468
469Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
470that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
471applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
472"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
473processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
474ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
475which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
476In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
477of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
478identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
479such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4802, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
481
482 listen foo
483 bind :80
484
485 listen bar
486 bind :81
487
488Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
489spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
490of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
491following configurations are strictly equivalent:
492
493 global#this is the global section
494 daemon#daemonize
495 frontend foo
496 mode http # or tcp
497
498and:
499
500 global
501 daemon
502
503 # this is the public web frontend
504 frontend foo
505 mode http
506
507The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
508new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
509other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
510section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
511section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
512at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
513
514Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
515are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
516editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
517support automatic indent.
518
519In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
520positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
521modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
522anymore, and is not recommended.
523
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200524
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005252.2. Quoting and escaping
526-------------------------
527
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100528In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
529that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
530possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
531in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
532('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200533
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100534This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
535very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
536the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
537also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
538delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
539word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
540remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200541
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100542If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
543(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
544
545Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
546backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200547
548 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
549 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
550 \\ to use a backslash
551 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
552 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
553
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100554In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
555C-language representation:
556
557 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
558 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
559 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
560 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
561
562Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
563or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
564of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100566 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200567 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
568 # hash as a comment start
569
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100570Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
571evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
572dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
573backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200574
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100575Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
576character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
577is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200578
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100579As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
580entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
581name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
582represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
583hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200584
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100585 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
586 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
587 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
588 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
589 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
590 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
591 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
592 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
593 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
594 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
595 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200596
597 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100598 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200599 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
601 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
602 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
603 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
604
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100605There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
606necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
607by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
608they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
609escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
610characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
611case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
612if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
613own quotes.
614
615The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600616quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500617not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100618quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
619
620Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
621arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
622
623 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
624 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
625
626Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
627"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
628cannot write:
629
630 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
631
632because we would like the string to cut like this:
633
634 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
635 |---------|----|-|
636 arg1 _/ / /
637 arg2 __________/ /
638 arg3 ______________/
639
640but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
641parenthesis then garbage:
642
643 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
644 |--------|--------|
645 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
646 trailing garbage _________/
647
648The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
649quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
650processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
651this word:
652
653 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
654 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
655 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
656
657So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
658still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
659the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
660the second level:
661
662 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
663 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
664 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
665 |---------||----|-|
666 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
667 arg2=blah ___________/ /
668 arg3=g _______________/
669
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500670Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100671double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
672
673 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
674 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
675 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
676 |---------||----|-|
677 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
678 arg2 ___________/ /
679 arg3 _______________/
680
681When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
682appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
683string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
684thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
685
686 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
687 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
688 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
689 |-------------| |-----||-|
690 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
691 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
692 arg3 ______________________/
693
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400694Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600695that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100696quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
697single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
698level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
699
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600700Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
701if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
702or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
703
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
705 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
706 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
707
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100708When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
709double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombscd34ad72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600710and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100711a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
712a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
713the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
714regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
715around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
716more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200717
718
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007192.3. Environment variables
720--------------------------
721
722HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
723interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
724configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
725optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
726shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200727underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
728list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
729arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100730before the closing brace. It is also possible to specify a default value to
731use when the variable is not set, by appending that value after a dash '-'
732next to the variable name. Note that the default value only replaces non
733existing variables, not empty ones.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200734
735 Example:
736
737 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
738
Willy Tarreauec347b12021-11-18 17:42:50 +0100739 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG-127.0.0.1}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200740
741 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
742
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200743Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
744file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200745
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200746* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
747 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
748
749* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
750 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
751 directory.
752
753* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
754
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500755* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200756 processes, separated by semicolons.
757
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500758* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200759 CLI, separated by semicolons.
760
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200761In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
762regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
763only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
764
765* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
766
767* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
768 starting at one.
769
770* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
771 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
772 first section.
773
774These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
775if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
776section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
777"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
778proxies.
779
780This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
781logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
782to name some config objects like servers for example.
783
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200784See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200785
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100786
7872.4. Conditional blocks
788-----------------------
789
790It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
791some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
792ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
793configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
794versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
795preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
796text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
797lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
798switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
799are defined to form conditional blocks:
800
801 - .if <condition>
802 - .elif <condition>
803 - .else
804 - .endif
805
806The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
807as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
808matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
809there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
810only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
811".elif" of a block.
812
813Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
814ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
815as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
816
Maximilian Maderfc0cceb2021-06-06 00:50:22 +0200817Conditions can also be evaluated on startup with the -cc parameter.
818See "3. Starting HAProxy" in the management doc.
819
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200820The conditions are either an empty string (which then returns false), or an
821expression made of any combination of:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100822
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100823 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
824 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200825 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200826 - a condition placed between a pair of parenthesis '(' and ')'
Kunal Gangakhedkard0bacde2021-08-17 11:55:45 +0530827 - an exclamation mark ('!') preceding any of the non-empty elements above,
828 and which will negate its status.
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200829 - expressions combined with a logical AND ('&&'), which will be evaluated
830 from left to right until one returns false
831 - expressions combined with a logical OR ('||'), which will be evaluated
832 from right to left until one returns true
833
834Note that like in other languages, the AND operator has precedence over the OR
835operator, so that "A && B || C && D" evalues as "(A && B) || (C && D)".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200836
837The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
838
839 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
840 exists, regardless of its contents
841
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200842 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
843 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
844 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
845
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200846 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
847 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
848
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200849 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
850 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
851 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
852 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
853
854 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
855 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
856 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
857 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
858
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200859Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100860
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200861 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
862 listen mwcli_px
863 bind :1111
864 ...
865 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200867 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
868 bind :80
869 .endif
870
871 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200872 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200873 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200874 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200875 .endif
876
Willy Tarreau316ea7e2021-07-16 14:56:59 +0200877 .if feature(OPENSSL) && (streq("$WITH_SSL",yes) || streq("$SSL_ONLY",yes))
Willy Tarreauca818872021-07-16 14:46:09 +0200878 bind :443 ssl crt ...
879 .endif
880
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200881 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
882 profiling.memory on
883 .endif
884
Willy Tarreauca56d3d2021-07-16 13:56:54 +0200885 .if !feature(OPENSSL)
886 .alert "SSL support is mandatory"
887 .endif
888
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200889Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100892 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
893 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
894 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
895
896Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
897"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
898fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
899provide advice to the user.
900
901Example:
902
903 .if "${A}"
904 .if "${B}"
905 .notice "A=1, B=1"
906 .elif "${C}"
907 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
908 .elif "${D}"
909 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
910 .else
911 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
912 .endif
913 .else
914 .notice "A=0"
915 .endif
916
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200917 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
918 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
919
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100920
9212.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200922----------------
923
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100924Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100925values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
926otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
927numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
928for every keyword. Supported units are :
929
930 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
931 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
932 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
933 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
934 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
935 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
936
937
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009382.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200939-------------
940
941 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
942 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
943 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
944 global
945 daemon
946 maxconn 256
947
948 defaults
949 mode http
950 timeout connect 5000ms
951 timeout client 50000ms
952 timeout server 50000ms
953
954 frontend http-in
955 bind *:80
956 default_backend servers
957
958 backend servers
959 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
960
961
962 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
963 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
964 global
965 daemon
966 maxconn 256
967
968 defaults
969 mode http
970 timeout connect 5000ms
971 timeout client 50000ms
972 timeout server 50000ms
973
974 listen http-in
975 bind *:80
976 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
977
978
979Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
980
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100981 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200982
983
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200985--------------------
986
987Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
988are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
989of them have command-line equivalents.
990
991The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
992
993 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200994 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200995 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200996 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200997 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200999 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - description
1001 - deviceatlas-json-file
1002 - deviceatlas-log-level
1003 - deviceatlas-separator
1004 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001005 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001006 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001007 - gid
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001008 - grace
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001009 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001010 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001011 - h1-case-adjust
1012 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001013 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001014 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001015 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001016 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001017 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001018 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001020 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001021 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001022 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001023 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001024 - mworker-max-reloads
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001025 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001026 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001027 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001028 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001029 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001030 - presetenv
1031 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001032 - uid
1033 - ulimit-n
1034 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001035 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001036 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001037 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001038 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001039 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001040 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001041 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001042 - ssl-default-bind-options
1043 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001044 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001045 - ssl-default-server-options
1046 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001047 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001048 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001049 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001050 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001051 - 51degrees-data-file
1052 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001053 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001054 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001055 - wurfl-data-file
1056 - wurfl-information-list
1057 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001058 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001059 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001060
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001061 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001062 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001063 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001064 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001065 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001066 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001067 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001068 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001069 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001070 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001071 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001072 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001073 - noepoll
1074 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001075 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001076 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001077 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001078 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001079 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001080 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001081 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001082 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001083 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001084 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001085 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001086 - tune.buffers.limit
1087 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001088 - tune.bufsize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001089 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001090 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001091 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001092 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001093 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001094 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001095 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001096 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001097 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001098 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001099 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001100 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001101 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1102 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001103 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001104 - tune.maxaccept
1105 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001106 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001107 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001108 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001109 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1110 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001111 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1112 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001113 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001114 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001115 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001116 - tune.sndbuf.client
1117 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001118 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001119 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001120 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001121 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001122 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001123 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001124 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02001125 - tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size
1126 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size (deprecated)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001127 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001128 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001129 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1130 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1131 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001132 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1133 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001134
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001135 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001136 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001137 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138
1139
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011403.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001141------------------------------------
1142
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001143ca-base <dir>
1144 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001145 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1146 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1147 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001148
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001149chroot <jail dir>
1150 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1151 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1152 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1153 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1154 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001155 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001156
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001157cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001158 On some operating systems, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001159 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1160 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1161 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1162 set. These sets have the format
1163
1164 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1165
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001166 <number> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
1167 word size. Any process IDs above 1 and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001168 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001169 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all thraeds at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001170 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1171 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001172 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1173 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1174 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1175 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1176 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1177 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1178 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1179 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1180 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1181 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001182
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001183 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1184 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1185 on the machine's word size.
1186
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001187 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001188 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing threads and
1189 CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same size. No matter the
1190 declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from the lowest to the
1191 highest bound. Having both a process and a thread range with the "auto:"
1192 prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one must be
1193 a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001194
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001195 Note that process ranges are supported for historical reasons. Nowadays, a
1196 lone number designates a process and must be 1, and specifying a thread range
1197 or number requires to prepend "1/" in front of it. Finally, "1" is strictly
1198 equivalent to "1/all" and designates all threads on the process.
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001199
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001200 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1202 # first 4 CPUs
1203
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001204 cpu-map 1/1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1/1-64 0-63"
1205 # or "cpu-map 1/1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001206 # word size.
1207
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001208 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1209 # and so on.
1210 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1211 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1212 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1213
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001214 # bind each thread to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
1215 cpu-map auto:1/all 0-63
1216 cpu-map auto:1/even 0-31
1217 cpu-map auto:1/odd 32-63
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001218
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001219 # invalid cpu-map because thread and CPU sets have different sizes.
1220 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0 # invalid
1221 cpu-map auto:1/1 0-3 # invalid
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001222
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001223crt-base <dir>
1224 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001225 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1226 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001227
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001228daemon
1229 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1230 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001231 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1232 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001233
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001234default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001235 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001236 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1237 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1238 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1239 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1240 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1241 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1242 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1243 not start with a slash ('/'):
1244 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1245 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1246
1247 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1248 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1249 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1250 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1251 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1252 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1253 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1254 each of them.
1255
1256 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1257 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1258 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1259 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1260 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1261 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1262 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1263 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1264
1265 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1266 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001267 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001268 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1269 made easily relocatable.
1270
1271 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1272 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1273 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1274 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1275 consistent across all configuration files.
1276
1277 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1278 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1279 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1280 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1281 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1282 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1283 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1284 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1285
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001286deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1287 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001288 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001289
1290deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001291 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001292 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1293
1294deviceatlas-separator <char>
1295 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1296 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1297
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001298deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001299 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1300 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1301 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001302
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001303expose-experimental-directives
1304 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1305 the config file will be rejected.
1306
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001307external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001308 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1309 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001310 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1311 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1312 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1313 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1314 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001315
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001316gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001317 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001318 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1319 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001320 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001321 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001322 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001323
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001324grace <time>
1325 Defines a delay between SIGUSR1 and real soft-stop.
1326
1327 Arguments :
1328 <time> is an extra delay (by default in milliseconds) after receipt of the
1329 SIGUSR1 signal that will be waited for before proceeding with the
1330 soft-stop operation.
1331
1332 This is used for compatibility with legacy environments where the haproxy
1333 process needs to be stopped but some external components need to detect the
1334 status before listeners are unbound. The principle is that the internal
1335 "stopping" variable (which is reported by the "stopping" sample fetch
1336 function) will be turned to true, but listeners will continue to accept
1337 connections undisturbed, until the delay expires, after what the regular
1338 soft-stop will proceed. This must not be used with processes that are
1339 reloaded, or this will prevent the old process from unbinding, and may
1340 prevent the new one from starting, or simply cause trouble.
1341
1342 Example:
1343
1344 global
1345 grace 10s
1346
1347 # Returns 200 OK until stopping is set via SIGUSR1
1348 frontend ext-check
1349 bind :9999
1350 monitor-uri /ext-check
1351 monitor fail if { stopping }
1352
1353 Please note that a more flexible and durable approach would instead consist
1354 for an orchestration system in setting a global variable from the CLI, use
1355 that variable to respond to external checks, then after a delay send the
1356 SIGUSR1 signal.
1357
1358 Example:
1359
1360 # Returns 200 OK until proc.stopping is set to non-zero. May be done
1361 # from HTTP using set-var(proc.stopping) or from the CLI using:
1362 # > set var proc.stopping int(1)
1363 frontend ext-check
1364 bind :9999
1365 monitor-uri /ext-check
1366 monitor fail if { var(proc.stopping) -m int gt 0 }
1367
1368 See also: hard-stop-after, monitor
1369
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001370group <group name>
1371 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1372 See also "gid" and "user".
1373
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001374hard-stop-after <time>
1375 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1376
1377 Arguments :
1378 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1379 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1380 SIGUSR1 signal.
1381
1382 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1383 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1384 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1385
1386 Example:
1387 global
1388 hard-stop-after 30s
1389
Willy Tarreau10080712021-09-07 10:49:45 +02001390 See also: grace
1391
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001392h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1393 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1394 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1395 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1396 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001397 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001398 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1399 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1400 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1401 specified in a proxy.
1402
1403 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1404 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1405 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1406 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1407 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1408 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1409 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1410
1411 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1412 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1413 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1414 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1415 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1416
1417 Example:
1418 global
1419 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1420
1421 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1422 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1423
1424h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1425 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1426 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1427 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1428 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1429 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1430 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1431 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1432 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1433
1434 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1435 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1436 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1437
1438 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1439 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1440
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001441insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001442 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001443 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1444 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1445 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1446 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1447 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1448 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1449 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001450 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001451 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1452 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1453 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1454 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1455 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1456 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1457 disable it.
1458
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001459insecure-setuid-wanted
1460 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1461 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1462 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1463 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001464 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001465 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001466 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001467 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1468 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001469 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001470 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1471 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1472 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1473 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1474
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001475issuers-chain-path <dir>
1476 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1477 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1478 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001479 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001480 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1481 "issuers-chain-path".
1482 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1483 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1484 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1485 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1486 will share the chain in memory.
1487
Amaury Denoyellebefeae82021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001488h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1489 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1490 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1491 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1492 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1493 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1494 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1495 the keyword with "no'.
1496
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001497localpeer <name>
1498 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1499 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1500 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1501 the configuration parsing.
1502
1503 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1504 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1505
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001506log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001507 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001508 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001509 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001510 configured with "log global".
1511
1512 <address> can be one of:
1513
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001514 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001515 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1516 port).
1517
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001518 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1519 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1520 port).
1521
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001522 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001523 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1524 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001525 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001526
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001527 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1528 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1529 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1530 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1531 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1532 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1533 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1534 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1535 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1536 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001537 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001538 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1539 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1540 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001541 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1542 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001543
1544 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1545 "fd@2", see above.
1546
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001547 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1548 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1549 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1550 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1551 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1552
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001553 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1554 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001555
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001556 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1557 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1558 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1559 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1560 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1561 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1562 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1563 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1564 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1565 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001566 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1567 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001568
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001569 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1570 one of the following :
1571
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001572 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1573 field is stripped. This is the default.
1574 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1575 rfc3164.
1576
1577 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001578 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1579
1580 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1581 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1582
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001583 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1584 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1585 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1586 designed to be used with a local log server.
1587
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001588 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1589 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1590 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1591 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1592 logger consumes.
1593
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001594 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1595 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1596 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1597 used with a local log server.
1598
1599 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1600 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1601 designed to be used with a local log server.
1602
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001603 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1604 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1605 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1606 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1607
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001608 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1609 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1610 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1611 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1612 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1613
1614 <sample_size>
1615 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1616 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1617 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1618 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1619 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1620
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001621 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001622
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001623 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1624 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1625 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1626
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001627 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1628 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1629 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1630 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001631
1632 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001633 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1634 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1635 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1636 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1637 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1638 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001639
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001640 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001641
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001642log-send-hostname [<string>]
1643 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1644 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1645 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1646 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1647 the logs.
1648
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001649log-tag <string>
1650 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1651 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1652 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001653 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001654
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001655lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001656 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1657 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1658 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1659 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1660 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1661 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001662 used multiple times.
1663
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001664lua-load-per-thread <file>
1665 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1666 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1667 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1668 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1669 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1670 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1671 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1672 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1673 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1674 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1675 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1676 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1677 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1678 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1679 times.
1680
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001681lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1682 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1683 variable.
1684 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1685 to "path".
1686
1687 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1688 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1689 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1690 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1691 will be checked earlier.
1692
1693 As an example by specifying the following path:
1694
1695 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1696 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1697
1698 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1699 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1700 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1701 paths if that does not exist either.
1702
1703 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1704 documentation.
1705
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001706master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001707 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1708 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1709 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001710 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001711 or daemon mode.
1712
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001713 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1714 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1715 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1716 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1717 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001718
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001719 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001720
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001721mworker-max-reloads <number>
1722 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001723 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001724 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1725 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1726 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1727
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001728nbthread <number>
1729 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02001730 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. "nbthread" also works when HAProxy is
1731 started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity, the default
1732 "nbthread" value is automatically set to the number of CPUs the process is
1733 bound to upon startup. This means that the thread count can easily be
1734 adjusted from the calling process using commands like "taskset" or "cpuset".
1735 Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default value is reported in the
1736 output of "haproxy -vv".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001737
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001738numa-cpu-mapping
Amaury Denoyelleb09f4472021-12-15 09:48:39 +01001739 If running on a NUMA-aware platform, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU
1740 topology of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity
1741 is automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done
1742 in order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the
1743 inter-socket bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a
1744 particular architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no
1745 numa-cpu-mapping'. This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread
1746 statement is present in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is
1747 already specified, for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset
1748 utility.
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001749
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001750pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001751 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1752 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1753 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1754 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001755
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001756pp2-never-send-local
1757 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1758 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1759 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1760 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1761 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1762 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1763 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1764 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1765 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1766 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1767 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1768
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001769presetenv <name> <value>
1770 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1771 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1772 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1773 and "unsetenv".
1774
1775resetenv [<name> ...]
1776 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1777 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1778 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1779 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1780 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1781 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1782 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1783 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1784
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001785stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02001786 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some stats
1787 instances on certain processes only. The default and only accepted value is
1788 "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this setting.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001789
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001790server-state-base <directory>
1791 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001792 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1793 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001794
1795server-state-file <file>
1796 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1797 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1798 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1799 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1800 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1801 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1802 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1803 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001804 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1805 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001806
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001807set-var <var-name> <expr>
1808 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1809 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1810 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1811 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1812 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1813 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001814 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It is
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001815 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1816 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1817
1818 Example:
1819 global
1820 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1821 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1822 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1823
Willy Tarreau753d4db2021-09-03 09:02:47 +02001824set-var-fmt <var-name> <fmt>
1825 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the string resulting from the
1826 evaluation of the log-format <fmt>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1827 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1828 'set-var-fmt' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is
1829 evaluated at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly
1830 set. The sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression
1831 are only those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'.
1832 It is possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These
1833 variables will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1834 Please see section 8.2.4 for details on the log-format syntax.
1835
1836 Example:
1837 global
1838 set-var-fmt proc.current_state "primary"
1839 set-var-fmt proc.bootid "%pid|%t"
1840
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001841setenv <name> <value>
1842 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1843 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1844 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1845 and "unsetenv".
1846
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001847set-dumpable
1848 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001849 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1850 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1851 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1852 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1853 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1854 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1855 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1856 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1857 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1858 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1859 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1860 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1861 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1862 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1863 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001864 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001865 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001866
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001867ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1868 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1869 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001870 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001871 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001872 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1873 information and recommendations see e.g.
1874 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1875 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1876 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1877 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001878
1879ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1880 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1881 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1882 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1883 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1884 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001885 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1886 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1887 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001888 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001889
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001890ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1891 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1892 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1893 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1894 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1895 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1896
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001897ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1898 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1899 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1900 keyword to see available options.
1901
1902 Example:
1903 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001904 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001905
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001906ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1907 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1908 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001909 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001910 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001911 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1912 information and recommendations see e.g.
1913 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1914 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1915 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1916 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1917 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001918
1919ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1920 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1921 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1922 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1923 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1924 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001925 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1926 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1927 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1928 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001929
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001930ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1931 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1932 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1933 keyword to see available options.
1934
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001935ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1936 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1937 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1938 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001939 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001940 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001941 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1942 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1943 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1944 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001945 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1946 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1947 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1948
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001949ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1950 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1951 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001952 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001953 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001954 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1955
1956 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001957
1958 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1959 and won't try to remove them.
1960
1961 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1962
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001963ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001964 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001965 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1966 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1967 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001968
1969 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1970 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1971 optimize the startup time.
1972
1973 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1974 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1975 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1976
1977 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001978 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001979
1980 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001981 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1982 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001983
1984 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1985 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1986 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1987 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1988 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001989 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001990
1991 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001992 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001993 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1994 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1995 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1996 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1997 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001998 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001999
2000 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
2001
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002002 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002003 a cert bundle.
2004
2005 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
2006 separately in several "crt".
2007
2008 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
2009 since files are loading separately.
2010
2011 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
2012 required to commit them.
2013
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02002014 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02002015 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002016
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002017 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2018 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2019 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002020
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002021 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
2022 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
2023 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002024
2025 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002026 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
2027 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002028
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01002029 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
2030 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
2031
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002032 The default behavior is "all".
2033
2034 Example:
2035 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
2036 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
2037 ssl-load-extra-files none
2038
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02002039 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
2040 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01002041
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01002042ssl-server-verify [none|required]
2043 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
2044 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
2045 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
2046
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002047ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04002048 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002049 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
2050 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
2051 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
2052 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
2053 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
2054 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02002055 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02002056
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002057stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
2058 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2059 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2060 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002061 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002062 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002063
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002064 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2065 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2066 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002067
2068stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2069 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2070 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002071 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002072
2073stats maxconn <connections>
2074 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2075 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2076
Willy Tarreaud04bc3a2021-09-27 13:55:10 +02002077thread-group <group> [<thread-range>...]
2078 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2079 enumerates the list of threads that will compose thread group <group>.
2080 Thread numbers and group numbers start at 1. Thread ranges are defined either
2081 using a single thread number at once, or by specifying the lower and upper
2082 bounds delimited by a dash '-' (e.g. "1-16"). Unassigned threads will be
2083 automatically assigned to unassigned thread groups, and thread groups
2084 defined with this directive will never receive more threads than those
2085 defined. Defining the same group multiple times overrides previous
2086 definitions with the new one. See also "nbthread" and "thread-groups".
2087
Willy Tarreauc33b9692021-09-22 12:07:23 +02002088thread-groups <number>
2089 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
2090 makes HAProxy split its threads into <number> independent groups. At the
2091 moment, the limit is 1 and is also the default value. See also "nbthread".
2092
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002093uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002094 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002095 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2096 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2097 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2098
2099ulimit-n <number>
2100 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2101 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2102 option.
2103
Amaury Denoyelle414a6122021-08-06 10:25:32 +02002104 Note that the dynamic servers are not taken into account in this automatic
2105 resource calculation. If using a large number of them, it may be needed to
2106 manually specify this value.
2107
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002108unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2109 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2110
2111 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2112 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2113 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2114 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2115 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002116 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002117 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2118 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2119 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2120 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2121
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002122unsetenv [<name> ...]
2123 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2124 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2125 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2126 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2127 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2128 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2129 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2130
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002131user <user name>
2132 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2133 See also "uid" and "group".
2134
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002135node <name>
2136 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2137
2138 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2139 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2140 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2141 traffic.
2142
2143description <text>
2144 Add a text that describes the instance.
2145
2146 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2147 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2148 "<" and ">" characters.
2149
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100215051degrees-data-file <file path>
2151 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002152 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002153
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002154 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002155 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2156
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000215751degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002158 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2159 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2160 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2161
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002162 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002163 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2164
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200216551degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002166 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2167 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002169 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002170 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2171
217251degrees-cache-size <number>
2173 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2174 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2175 By default, this cache is disabled.
2176
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002177 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002178 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2179
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002180wurfl-data-file <file path>
2181 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2182 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2183
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002184 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002185 with USE_WURFL=1.
2186
2187wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2188 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2189 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2190 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2191
2192 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2193
2194 Valid WURFL properties are:
2195 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2196
2197 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2198 device.
2199
2200 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2201 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2202
2203 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2204 particular web request.
2205
2206 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2207 used Libwurfl API version.
2208
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002209 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2210 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2211
2212 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2213 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2214
2215 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2216
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002217 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002218 with USE_WURFL=1.
2219
2220wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2221 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2222 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2223
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002224 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002225 with USE_WURFL=1.
2226
2227wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2228 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2229 thus before the chroot.
2230
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002231 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002232 with USE_WURFL=1.
2233
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002234wurfl-cache-size <size>
2235 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2236 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002237 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002238 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002239
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002240 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002241 with USE_WURFL=1.
2242
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002243strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002244 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002245 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2246 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002247 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002248 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002249
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022503.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002251-----------------------
2252
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002253busy-polling
2254 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2255 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2256 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2257 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2258 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2259 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2260 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2261 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2262 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2263 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2264 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2265 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2266 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2267 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2268 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2269 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2270 "poll" pollers.
2271
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002272 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2273 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2274 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2275
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002276max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002277 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002278 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2279 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2280 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2281 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2282 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2283 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2284 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2285
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002286maxconn <number>
2287 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2288 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2289 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002290 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2291 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2292 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2293 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002294 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2295 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2296 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2297 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2298 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2299 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002300
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002301maxconnrate <number>
2302 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2303 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2304 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2305 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2306 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2307 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2308 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2309 fairness.
2310
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002311maxcomprate <number>
2312 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002313 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002314 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2315 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2316 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002317 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002318 default value.
2319
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002320maxcompcpuusage <number>
2321 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2322 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2323 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002324 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. A
2325 value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting a lower
2326 value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole process down
2327 and from introducing high latencies.
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002328
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002329maxpipes <number>
2330 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2331 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2332 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2333 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2334 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2335 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2336
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002337maxsessrate <number>
2338 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2339 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2340 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2341 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2342 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2343 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2344 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2345 fairness.
2346
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002347maxsslconn <number>
2348 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2349 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2350 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2351 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2352 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2353 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2354 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002355 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2356 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2357 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2358 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002359 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002360 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2361 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002362
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002363maxsslrate <number>
2364 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2365 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2366 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2367 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2368 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2369 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2370 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2371 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2372 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2373 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2374
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002375maxzlibmem <number>
2376 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2377 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2378 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002379 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2380 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2381 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2382
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002383noepoll
2384 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2385 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002386 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002387
2388nokqueue
2389 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2390 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2391 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2392
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002393noevports
2394 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2395 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2396 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2397 also "nopoll".
2398
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002399nopoll
2400 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2401 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002402 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002403 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2404 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002405
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002406nosplice
2407 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002408 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002409 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002410 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002411 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2412 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2413 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2414 "option splice-response".
2415
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002416nogetaddrinfo
2417 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2418 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2419
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002420noreuseport
2421 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2422 command line argument "-dR".
2423
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002424profiling.memory { on | off }
2425 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2426 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2427 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2428 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2429 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2430 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2431 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2432 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2433 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2434
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002435profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2436 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2437 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2438 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2439 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002440 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002441 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2442 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2443 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2444 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2445
2446 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2447 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2448 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2449 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2450 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002451 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2452 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2453 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2454 CLI.
2455
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002456spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002457 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2458 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2459 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2460 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2461 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2462 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002463
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002464ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002465 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002466 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002467 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002468 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002469 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2470 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2471 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002472 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2473 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002474 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2475 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2476 openssl configuration file uses:
2477 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2478
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002479ssl-mode-async
2480 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002481 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002482 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2483 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002484 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002485 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002486 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002487
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002488tune.buffers.limit <number>
2489 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2490 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2491 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2492 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2493 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002494 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002495 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2496 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2497 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2498 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2499 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2500 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2501 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2502 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002503 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002504
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002505tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2506 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2507 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2508 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002509 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002510
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002511tune.bufsize <number>
2512 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2513 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2514 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2515 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2516 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2517 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2518 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002519 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2520 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002521 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002522 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002523 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002524 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2525 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002526
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002527tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2528 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2529 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2530 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2531 this value. The default value is 1.
2532
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002533tune.fail-alloc
2534 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2535 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2536 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2537 gracefully.
2538
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002539tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2540 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2541 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2542 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2543 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2544 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2545
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002546tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2547 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2548 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2549 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2550 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2551 change it.
2552
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002553tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2554 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002555 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002556 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002557 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2558 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2559 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2560 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2561 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2562
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002563tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2564 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2565 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2566 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2567 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2568 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002569 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002570 recommended not to change this value.
2571
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002572tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002573 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002574 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002575 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002576 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2577 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2578 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2579 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2580
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002581tune.http.cookielen <number>
2582 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2583 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2584 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2585 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2586 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2587 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2588 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2589 to change this value.
2590
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002591tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002592 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2593 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002594 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002595 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002596 configuration directives too.
2597 The default value is 1024.
2598
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002599tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2600 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2601 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2602 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2603 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2604 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2605 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002606 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2607 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2608 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002609
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002610tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2611 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2612 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2613 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2614 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2615 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2616 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002617 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2618 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2619 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2620 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2621 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002622
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002623tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002624 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002625 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2626 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2627 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2628 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002629 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002630 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002631 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002632 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2633
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002634tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2635 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2636 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2637 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2638 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2639 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2640 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2641 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2642 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2643 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2644
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002645tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2646 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002647 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002648 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2649 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002650 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002651 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2652 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2653
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002654tune.lua.maxmem
2655 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2656 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2657 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2658 memory.
2659
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002660tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2661 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002662 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2663 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002664 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002665
2666tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2667 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2668 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2669 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2670 check servers.
2671
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002672tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2673 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2674 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2675 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002676 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002677
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002678tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002679 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2680 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002681 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2682 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2683 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2684 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2685 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2686 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2687 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2688 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2689 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002690
2691tune.maxpollevents <number>
2692 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2693 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2694 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2695 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2696 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2697
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002698tune.maxrewrite <number>
2699 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2700 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2701 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2702 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2703 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2704 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2705 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2706 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2707 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2708 bufsize.
2709
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002710tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2711 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2712 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2713 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2714 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2715 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2716 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2717 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2718 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2719 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002720 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2721 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002722 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2723 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2724 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2725 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2726 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2727 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2728 setting this parameter to 0.
2729
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002730tune.pipesize <number>
2731 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2732 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2733 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2734 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2735 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2736 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2737
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002738tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2739 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002740 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002741 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2742 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2743 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2744 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002745 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002746
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002747tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2748 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002749 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002750 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2751 default is 20.
2752
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002753tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2754tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2755 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2756 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2757 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002758 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002759 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002760 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2761 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2762
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002763tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002764 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002765 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2766 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2767 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2768 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2769
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002770tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002771 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002772 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2773 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2774 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2775 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2776 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2777 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2778 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002779
2780tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2781 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002782 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002783 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2784 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2785 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2786 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2787 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2788 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2789 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002790
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002791tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2792tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2793 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2794 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2795 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002796 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002797 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002798 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2799 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2800 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2801 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002802 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002803
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002804tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002805 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002806 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2807 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2808 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2809 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2810 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2811 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2812 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2813 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2814 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02002815 pre-allocated upon startup. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session
2816 cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002817
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002818tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002819 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002820 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2821 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2822 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2823 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2824 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2825
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002826tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2827 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2828 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2829 performances. This is disabled by default.
2830
2831 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2832 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2833
2834 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2835
2836 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2837
2838 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2839
2840 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2841 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2842 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2843
2844 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2845 converted.
2846
2847 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2848 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2849 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2850 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2851 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2852 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2853 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002854 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2855 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002856
2857 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2858
2859 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2860 only need this line:
2861
2862 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2863
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002864tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2865 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002866 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002867 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2868 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2869 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2870 being used for too long.
2871
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002872tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2873 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2874 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2875 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2876 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2877 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2878 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2879 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2880 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2881 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2882 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002883 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002884 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002885
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002886tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2887 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2888 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2889 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2890 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002891 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002892 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2893 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002894 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2895 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002896
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002897tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2898 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2899 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2900 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2901 1000 entries.
2902
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +02002903tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size <number>
2904tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number> (deprecated)
Marcin Deranek769fd2e2021-07-12 14:16:55 +02002905 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client hello cipher
2906 list, extensions list, elliptic curves list and elliptic curve point
2907 formats. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled,
2908 otherwise a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002909
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002910tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002911tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002912tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2913tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2914tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002915 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2916 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2917 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2918 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2919 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2920 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2921 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2922 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002923
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002924 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2925 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2926 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2927 all available space is consumed.
2928 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2929 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2930 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002931
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002932tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2933 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002934 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002935 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002936 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002937 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2938
2939tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2940 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2941 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002942 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2943 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002944
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020029453.3. Debugging
2946--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002947
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002948quiet
2949 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2950 line argument "-q".
2951
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002952zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002953 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002954 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2955 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2956 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2957 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2958 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2959
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002960
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029613.4. Userlists
2962--------------
2963It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2964http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2965it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2966
2967userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002968 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002969 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2970
2971group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002972 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002973 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2974 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2975
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002976user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2977 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002978 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2979 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002980 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2981 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2982 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2983 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002984
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002985 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2986 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2987 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2988 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2989 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2990 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2991 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002992 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002993 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002994
2995 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002996 userlist L1
2997 group G1 users tiger,scott
2998 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002999
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003000 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
3001 user scott insecure-password elgato
3002 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003003
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003004 userlist L2
3005 group G1
3006 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003007
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003008 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
3009 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
3010 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003011
3012 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003013
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003014
30153.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003016----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003017It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003018several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003019instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
Willy Tarreaudb2ab822021-10-08 17:53:12 +02003020values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. As an exception, the data
3021type "conn_cur" is never learned from peers, as it is supposed to reflect local
3022values. Earlier versions used to synchronize it and to cause negative values in
3023active-active setups, and always-growing values upon reloads or active-passive
3024switches because the local value would reflect more connections than locally
3025present. This information, however, is pushed so that monitoring systems can
3026watch it.
3027
3028Interrupted exchanges are automatically detected and recovered from the last
3029known point. In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to
3030the new one using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new
3031process tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication
3032during a reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large
3033tables.
3034
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02003035Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
3036that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
3037each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003038
3039peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003040 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003041 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
3042
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003043bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
3044 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
3045 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
3046
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003047disabled
3048 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
3049 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
3050 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
3051
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003052default-bind [param*]
3053 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
3054
3055default-server [param*]
3056 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
3057
3058 Arguments:
3059 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3060 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3061 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3062 details.
3063
3064
3065 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
3066
Emeric Brun620761f2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02003067enabled
3068 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3069 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003070
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003071log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003072 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3073 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3074 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3075 more details.
3076
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003077peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003078 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3079 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003080 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003081 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003082 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3083 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3084 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003085
3086 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3087 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3088
3089 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003090 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3091 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3092 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003093
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003094 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3095 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003096
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003097 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3098 "server" keyword explanation below).
3099
3100server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003101 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003102 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph.
3103 If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port> parameters must not be present.
3104 These parameters must be provided on a "bind" line (see "bind" keyword
3105 of this "peers" section).
3106 Some of these parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections.
3107
3108
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003109 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003110 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003111 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003112 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3113 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3114 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003115
3116 backend mybackend
3117 mode tcp
3118 balance roundrobin
3119 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3120 stick on src
3121
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003122 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3123 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003124
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003125 Example:
3126 peers mypeers
3127 bind 127.0.0.11:10001 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3128 default-server ssl verify none
3129 server hostA 127.0.0.10:10000
3130 server hostB #local peer
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003131
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003132
3133table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3134 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3135
3136 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3137 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003138 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003139 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3140 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3141 "stick-table" keyword).
3142
3143 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3144 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3145 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3146 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3147 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3148 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3149 of the stick-table name as follows:
3150
3151 peers mypeers
3152 peer A ...
3153 peer B ...
3154 table t1 ...
3155
3156 frontend fe1
3157 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3158
3159 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3160 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3161
3162 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3163 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3164 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3165 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3166 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3167 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3168 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3169
3170 peers mypeers
3171 peer A ...
3172 peer B ...
3173 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3174
3175 backend t1
3176 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3177
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003178 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003179 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3180 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3181
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031823.6. Mailers
3183------------
3184It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3185If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3186in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3187
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003188mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003189 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3190 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3191
3192mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3193 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3194
3195 Example:
3196 mailers mymailers
3197 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3198 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3199
3200 backend mybackend
3201 mode tcp
3202 balance roundrobin
3203
3204 email-alert mailers mymailers
3205 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3206 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3207
3208 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3209 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3210
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003211timeout mail <time>
3212 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3213 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3214 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3215 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3216
3217 Example:
3218 mailers mymailers
3219 timeout mail 20s
3220 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003221
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020032223.7. Programs
3223-------------
3224In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3225master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3226managed the same way as the workers.
3227
3228During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3229sequence as a worker:
3230
3231 - the master is re-executed
3232 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3233 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3234 instance of the program
3235
3236During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3237
3238program <name>
3239 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3240 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3241 the management guide).
3242
3243command <command> [arguments*]
3244 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3245 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3246 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3247 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3248
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003249user <user name>
3250 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3251 See also "group".
3252
3253group <group name>
3254 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3255 See also "user".
3256
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003257option start-on-reload
3258no option start-on-reload
3259 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3260 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3261 program section.
3262
3263
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032643.8. HTTP-errors
3265----------------
3266
3267It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3268imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3269several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3270
3271http-errors <name>
3272 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3273 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3274
3275errorfile <code> <file>
3276 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3277
3278 Arguments :
3279 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003280 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003281 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003282
3283 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3284 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3285 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3286 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3287 before any chroot is performed.
3288
3289 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3290
3291 Example:
3292 http-errors website-1
3293 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3294 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3295 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3296
3297 http-errors website-2
3298 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3299 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3300 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3301
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020033023.9. Rings
3303----------
3304
3305It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3306servers or traces.
3307
3308ring <ringname>
3309 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3310
3311description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003312 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003313 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3314
3315format <format>
3316 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3317
3318 Arguments:
3319 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3320 one of the following :
3321
3322 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3323 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3324 designed to be used with a local log server.
3325
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003326 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3327 field is stripped. This is the default.
3328 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3329 rfc3164.
3330
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003331 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3332 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3333 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3334 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3335 is the default.
3336
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003337 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003338 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3339
3340 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3341 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3342
3343 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3344 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3345 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3346 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3347 logger consumes.
3348
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003349 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3350 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3351 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3352 with a local log server.
3353
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003354 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3355 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3356 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3357 used with a local log server.
3358
3359maxlen <length>
3360 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3361 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3362 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3363
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003364server <name> <address> [param*]
3365 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3366 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3367 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3368 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3369 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3370 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3371 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3372 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3373 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003374 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3375 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003376
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003377size <size>
3378 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3379 set to BUFSIZE.
3380
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003381timeout connect <timeout>
3382 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3383
3384 Arguments :
3385 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3386 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3387 as explained at the top of this document.
3388
3389timeout server <timeout>
3390 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3391
3392 Arguments :
3393 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3394 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3395 as explained at the top of this document.
3396
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003397 Example:
3398 global
3399 log ring@myring local7
3400
3401 ring myring
3402 description "My local buffer"
3403 format rfc3164
3404 maxlen 1200
3405 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003406 timeout connect 5s
3407 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003408 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003409
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020034103.10. Log forwarding
3411-------------------
3412
3413It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003414HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003415
3416log-forward <name>
3417 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3418
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003419backlog <conns>
3420 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3421 on connections accept.
3422
3423bind <addr> [param*]
3424 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003425 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3426 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3427 syslog protocol over TCP.
3428 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003429 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3430
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003431dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003432 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3433 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3434 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3435 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003436 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003437
3438log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003439log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003440 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3441 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3442 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003443 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003444 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3445 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3446 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003447 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003448
3449 Example:
3450 global
3451 log stderr format iso local7
3452
3453 ring myring
3454 description "My local buffer"
3455 format rfc5424
3456 maxlen 1200
3457 size 32764
3458 timeout connect 5s
3459 timeout server 10s
3460 # syslog tcp server
3461 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3462
3463 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003464 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3465 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003466 # all messages on stderr
3467 log global
3468 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3469 log ring@myring local0
3470 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3471 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3472 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3473 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3474 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003475
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003476maxconn <conns>
3477 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3478 10 is the default.
3479
3480timeout client <timeout>
3481 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3482
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034834. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003484----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003485
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003486Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003487 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3488 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3489 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3490 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003491
3492A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3493connections.
3494
3495A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3496to forward incoming connections.
3497
3498A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3499parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3500
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003501A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3502ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3503sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3504the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3505explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3506from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3507"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3508for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3509to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3510optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3511are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3512any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3513names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3514that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3515duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
Christopher Fauletb4054202021-10-12 18:57:43 +02003516names. This rule might be enforced in a future version. In addition, a warning
3517is emitted if a defaults section is explicitly used by a proxy while it is also
3518implicitly used by another one because it is the last one defined. It is highly
3519encouraged to not mix both usages by always using explicit references or by
3520adding a last common defaults section reserved for all implicit uses.
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003521
3522Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3523settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3524of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3525profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3526timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3527
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003528All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3529'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3530case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3531
3532Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3533logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3534proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3535However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3536name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3537
3538Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3539and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003540bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003541protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3542modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3543arbitrary criteria.
3544
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003545In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3546a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003547the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003548
3549 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3550 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3551 between responses and new requests.
3552
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003553 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3554 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3555 client-facing connection remains open.
3556
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003557 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3558 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003559
3560The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3561frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3562following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003563weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003564
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003565 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003566
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003567 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3568 ----+-----+-----+----
3569 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3570 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003571 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3572 ----+-----+-----+----
3573 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003574
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003575It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003576only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3577within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003578as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003579content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003580and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3581possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003582
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003583There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003584first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003585processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003586second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003587protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3588is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3589new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003590to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003591process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3592already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3593HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3594evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3595one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3596
3597There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3598performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3599tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3600preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3601analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3602HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3603header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3604mitigate this drawback.
3605
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003606There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003607method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3608set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3609in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3610is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3611to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3612above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3613to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3614"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3615frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3616frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3617as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3618upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3619on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3620the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3621upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3622frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3623remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003624
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020036254.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3626--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003627
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003628The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3629limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3630they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3631limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003632marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003633option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003634and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3635with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003636specified in a previous "defaults" section. Keywords supported in defaults
3637sections marked with "(!)" are only supported in named defaults sections, not
3638anonymous ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003639
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003640
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003641 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3642------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003643acl X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003644backlog X X X -
3645balance X - X X
3646bind - X X -
3647bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003648capture cookie - X X -
3649capture request header - X X -
3650capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003651clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3652clitcpka-idle X X X -
3653clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003654compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003656declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003657default-server X - X X
3658default_backend X X X -
3659description - X X X
3660disabled X X X X
3661dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003662email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003663email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003664email-alert mailers X X X X
3665email-alert myhostname X X X X
3666email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003667enabled X X X X
3668errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003669errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003670errorloc X X X X
3671errorloc302 X X X X
3672-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3673errorloc303 X X X X
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02003674error-log-format X X X -
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003675force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003676filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003677fullconn X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003678hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003679http-after-response X (!) X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003680http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003681http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003682http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003683http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003684http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003685http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003686http-check set-var X - X X
3687http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003688http-error X X X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003689http-request X (!) X X X
3690http-response X (!) X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003691http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003692http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003694ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003695load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003696log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003697log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003698log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003699log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003700max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003701maxconn X X X -
3702mode X X X X
3703monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003704monitor-uri X X X -
3705option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3706option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3707option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3708option allbackups (*) X - X X
3709option checkcache (*) X - X X
3710option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3711option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003712option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003713option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3714option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003715-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3716option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003717option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3718option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003719option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003720option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003721option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003722option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003723option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003724option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3725option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3726option httpchk X - X X
3727option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003728option httplog X X X -
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02003729option httpslog X X X -
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003730option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003731option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003732option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003733option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3734option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3735option logasap (*) X X X -
3736option mysql-check X - X X
3737option nolinger (*) X X X X
3738option originalto X X X X
3739option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003740option pgsql-check X - X X
3741option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003743option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003744option smtpchk X - X X
3745option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3746option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3747option splice-request (*) X X X X
3748option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003749option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3751option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3752-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003753option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003754option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3755option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3756option tcpka X X X X
3757option tcplog X X X X
3758option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003759option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003760external-check command X - X X
3761external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003762persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3763rate-limit sessions X X X -
3764redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003765-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003766retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003767retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003768server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003769server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003770server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003771source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003772srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3773srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3774srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003775stats admin - X X X
3776stats auth X X X X
3777stats enable X X X X
3778stats hide-version X X X X
3779stats http-request - X X X
3780stats realm X X X X
3781stats refresh X X X X
3782stats scope X X X X
3783stats show-desc X X X X
3784stats show-legends X X X X
3785stats show-node X X X X
3786stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003787-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3788stick match - - X X
3789stick on - - X X
3790stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003791stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003792stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003793tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003794tcp-check connect X - X X
3795tcp-check expect X - X X
3796tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003797tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003798tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003799tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003800tcp-check set-var X - X X
3801tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003802tcp-request connection X (!) X X -
3803tcp-request content X (!) X X X
3804tcp-request inspect-delay X (!) X X X
3805tcp-request session X (!) X X -
3806tcp-response content X (!) - X X
3807tcp-response inspect-delay X (!) - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003808timeout check X - X X
3809timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003810timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003811timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003812timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3813timeout http-request X X X X
3814timeout queue X - X X
3815timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003816timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003817timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003818timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003819transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003820unique-id-format X X X -
3821unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003822use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003823use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003824use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003825------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3826 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003827
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003828
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020038294.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3830---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003831
3832This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3833
3834
3835acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3836 Declare or complete an access list.
3837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02003838 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
3839
3840 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
3841 ones. ACLs defined in a defaults section are not visible from other sections
3842 using it.
3843
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003844 Example:
3845 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3846 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3847 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3848
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003849 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003850
3851
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003852backlog <conns>
3853 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3855 yes | yes | yes | no
3856 Arguments :
3857 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3858 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003859 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003860
3861 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3862 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3863 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3864 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3865 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3866 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3867 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3868 backlog parameter.
3869
3870 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3871 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3872 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3873
3874 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3875
3876
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003878balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003879 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3880 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3881 yes | no | yes | yes
3882 Arguments :
3883 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3884 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3885 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3886 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3887
3888 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3889 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3890 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3891 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003892 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003893 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003894 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3895 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3896 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3897 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3898 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3899 it, so that you don't worry.
3900
3901 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3902 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3903 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3904 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3905 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3906 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3907 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3908 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003909
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003910 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3911 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3912 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3913 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3914 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3915 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3916 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003917 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3918 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3919 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003920
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003921 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003922 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003923 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3924 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003925 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003926 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3927 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3928 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3929 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3930 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003931 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3932 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3933 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3934 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3935 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3936 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003937
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003938 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3939 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3940 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3941 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3942 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3943 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3944 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3945 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003946 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003947 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003948 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3949 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3950 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003951
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003952 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3953 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3954 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3955 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3956 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3957 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3958 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3959 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3960 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3961 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3962 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3963 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003964
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003965 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003966 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3967 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3968 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3969 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3970 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3971 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3972 URIs start with a leading "/".
3973
3974 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3975 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3976 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3977 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3978
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003979 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3980 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3981 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3982 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3983
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003984 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003985 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3986
3987 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003988 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3989 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003990 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3991 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3992 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3993 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003994 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003995 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3996 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003997
3998 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3999 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
4000 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
4001 server will receive the request.
4002
4003 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
4004 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
4005 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
4006 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
4007 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004008 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
4009 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
4010 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004011
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004012 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
4013 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
4014 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
4015 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
4016 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004017
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004018 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004019 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
4020 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
4021 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
4022
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004023 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4024 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4025 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4026
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004027 random
4028 random(<draws>)
4029 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004030 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
4031 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
4032 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
4033 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01004034 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
4035 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
4036 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
4037 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
4038 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
4039 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
4040 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
4041 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
4042 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
4043 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
4044 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
4045 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
4046 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
4047 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
4048 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
4049 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
4050 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
4051 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
4052 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
4053 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02004054
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004055 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02004056 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004057 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
4058 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
4059 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
4060 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
4061 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
4062 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004063 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02004064 used instead.
4065
4066 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
4067 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
4068 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
4069 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
4070
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02004071 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
4072 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
4073 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4074
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02004075 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09004076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004077 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004078 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4079 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004080
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004081 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4082 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4083 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004084
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004085 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004086 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004087 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4088 NTLM relies on.
4089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004090 Examples :
4091 balance roundrobin
4092 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004093 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004094 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4095 balance hdr(host)
4096 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004097
4098 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4099 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4100
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004101 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004102 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4103 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4104 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004105 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004106
4107 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4108 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4109 defaults to 16 kB.
4110
4111 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4112 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4113
4114 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4115 Round Robin.
4116
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004117 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004118 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4119 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4120 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4121
4122 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4123
4124 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004125 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004126 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4127 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4128 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004129
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +02004130 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004131
4132
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004133bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4134bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004135 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4136 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4137 no | yes | yes | no
4138 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004139 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4140 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4141 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4142 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004143 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004144 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4145 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4146 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4147 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4148 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4149 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004150 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004151 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4152 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004153 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004154 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4155 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004156 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004157 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4158 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004159 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004160 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004161 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4162 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4163 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004164 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4165 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4166 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4167 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004168 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4169 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4170 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004171
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004172 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4173 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004174 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4175 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4176 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004177 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4178 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4179 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4180 the range.
4181
4182 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4183 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4184 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4185 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4186 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4187 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4188 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004189 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004190 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004191
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004192 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004193 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004194 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4195 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4196 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4197 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4198 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4199 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4200
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004201 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4202 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4203 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4204 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004205
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004206 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4207 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4208 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4209 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4210 in a frontend.
4211
4212 Example :
4213 listen http_proxy
4214 bind :80,:443
4215 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004216 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004217
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004218 listen http_https_proxy
4219 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004220 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004221
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004222 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4223 bind ipv6@:80
4224 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4225 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4226
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004227 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004228 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004229
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004230 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4231 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4232 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4233 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4234 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4235
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004236 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004237 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004238
4239
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004240bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004241 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4242 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004243
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +02004244 Deprecated. Before threads were supported, this was used to force some
4245 frontends on certain processes only, or to adjust backends so that they
4246 could match the frontends that used them. The default and only accepted
4247 value is "1" (along with "all" and "odd" which alias it). Do not use this
4248 setting. Threads can still be bound per-socket using the "process" bind
4249 keyword.
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004250
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +02004251 See also : "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004252
4253
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004254capture cookie <name> len <length>
4255 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4256 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4257 no | yes | yes | no
4258 Arguments :
4259 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4260 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4261 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4262 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004263 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004264
4265 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4266 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4267 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4268 right if it exceeds <length>.
4269
4270 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4271 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4272 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4273 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4274
4275 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4276 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4277 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4278
4279 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4280 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4281 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004282 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4283 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4284 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004285
4286 Example:
4287 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4288
4289 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004290 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291
4292
4293capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004294 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4296 no | yes | yes | no
4297 Arguments :
4298 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004299 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004300 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4301 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4302 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4303
4304 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4305 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4306 it exceeds <length>.
4307
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004308 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004309 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4310 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004311 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4312 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4313 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4314 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004315 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004316 environments to find where the request came from.
4317
4318 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4319 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4320 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4321 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004323 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4324 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4325 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4326 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4327 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004328
4329 Example:
4330 capture request header Host len 15
4331 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004332 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004333
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004334 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004335 about logging.
4336
4337
4338capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004339 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4341 no | yes | yes | no
4342 Arguments :
4343 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004344 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004345 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4346 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4347 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4348
4349 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4350 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4351 it exceeds <length>.
4352
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004353 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004354 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4355 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4356 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004357 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4358 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4359 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4360 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004361
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004362 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4363 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4364 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4365 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4366 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004367
4368 Example:
4369 capture response header Content-length len 9
4370 capture response header Location len 15
4371
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004372 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004373 about logging.
4374
4375
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004376clitcpka-cnt <count>
4377 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4378 the connection on the client side.
4379 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4380 yes | yes | yes | no
4381 Arguments :
4382 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4383
4384 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4385 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004386 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4387 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004388
4389 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4390
4391
4392clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4393 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4394 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4395 client side.
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | yes | yes | no
4398 Arguments :
4399 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4400 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4401 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4402 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4403
4404 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4405 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004406 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4407 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004408
4409 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4410
4411
4412clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4413 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4415 yes | yes | yes | no
4416 Arguments :
4417 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4418 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4419 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4420 document.
4421
4422 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4423 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004424 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4425 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004426
4427 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4428
4429
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004430compression algo <algorithm> ...
4431compression type <mime type> ...
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004432 Enable HTTP compression.
4433 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4434 yes | yes | yes | yes
4435 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004436 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4437 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004438
4439 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004440 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4441 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4442 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004443
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004444 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004445 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004446
4447 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4448 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4449 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4450 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4451 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004452 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004453
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004454 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4455 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4456 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4457 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4458 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4459 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4460 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004461 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004462
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004463 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004464 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004465 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004466 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004467 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004468 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004469 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004470
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004471 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004472 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4473 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004474 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004475 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004476 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4477 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4478 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4479 "multipart"
4480 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4481 header
4482 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4483 and later
4484 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4485 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004486 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004487
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004488 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004489
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004490 Examples :
4491 compression algo gzip
4492 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004493
Christopher Faulet44d34bf2021-11-05 12:06:14 +01004494 See also : "compression offload"
4495
4496compression offload
4497 Makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only.
4498 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4499 no | yes | yes | yes
4500
4501 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
4502 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4503 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
4504 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4505 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
4506 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
4507 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
4508 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4509 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
4510 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
4511 then be used for such scenarios.
4512
4513 If this setting is used in a defaults section, a warning is emitted and the
4514 option is ignored.
4515
4516 See also : "compression type", "compression algo"
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004517
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004518cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004519 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4520 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004521 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004522 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4523 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4524 yes | no | yes | yes
4525 Arguments :
4526 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4527 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4528 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4529 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4530 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4531 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004532 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004533 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4534 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4535
4536 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004537 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004538 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4539 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4540 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4541 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004542 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4543 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004544 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004545 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4546 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004547
4548 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004549 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004550
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004551 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004552 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004553 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004554 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004555 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4556 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4557 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4558 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4559 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4560 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4561 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004562
4563 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4564 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4565 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4566 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4567 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4568 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4569 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4570 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4571 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004572 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004573 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4574 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4575 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004576
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004577 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4578 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4579 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004580 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4581 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4582 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4583 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004584 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4585 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4586 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004587
4588 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4589 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4590 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4591 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4592 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4593 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4594 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4595 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4596 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4597
4598 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4599 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4600 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4601 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4602 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4603 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4604 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4605 persistence cookie in the cache.
4606 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4607
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004608 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4609 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004610 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004611 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4612 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004613 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004614 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4615 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4616 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4617 they logout.
4618
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004619 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004620 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4621 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4622 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4623
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004624 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004625 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4626 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4627 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4628 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4629 this attribute.
4630
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004631 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004632 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004633 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4634 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4635 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4636 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4637 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4638 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004639
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004640 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4641 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4642 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4643 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4644 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4645 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4646 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4647 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004648 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004649 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4650 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4651 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4652 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4653 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4654 the site.
4655
4656 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4657 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4658 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4659 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4660 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4661 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4662 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4663 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4664 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4665 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4666 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4667 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4668 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004669 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004670 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4671 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4672
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004673 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4674 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4675 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4676 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4677 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4678 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4679
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004680 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004681 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4682 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4683 repeated.
4684
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004685 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4686 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4687 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4688 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004689
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004690 Examples :
4691 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4692 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4693 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004694 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004695
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004696 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004697
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004698
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004699declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4700 Declares a capture slot.
4701 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4702 no | yes | yes | no
4703 Arguments:
4704 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4705
4706 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4707 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4708 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4709 for use in the response.
4710
4711 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004712 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004713 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4714
4715
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004716default-server [param*]
4717 Change default options for a server in a backend
4718 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4719 yes | no | yes | yes
4720 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004721 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4722 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4723 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4724 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004725
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004726 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004727 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4728
4729 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004730
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004731
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004732default_backend <backend>
4733 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4734 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4735 yes | yes | yes | no
4736 Arguments :
4737 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4738
4739 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4740 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4741 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4742 will catch all undetermined requests.
4743
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004744 Example :
4745
4746 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4747 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4748 default_backend dynamic
4749
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004750 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004751
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004752
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004753description <string>
4754 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4756 no | yes | yes | yes
4757 Arguments : string
4758
4759 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4760 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4761 it describes.
4762 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4763
4764
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004765disabled
4766 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4767 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4768 yes | yes | yes | yes
4769 Arguments : none
4770
4771 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4772 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4773 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4774 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4775 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4776 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4777 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4778
4779 See also : "enabled"
4780
4781
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004782dispatch <address>:<port>
4783 Set a default server address
4784 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4785 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004786 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004787
4788 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4789 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4790 during start-up.
4791
4792 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4793 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4794 possible with normal servers.
4795
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004796 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004797 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4798 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4799 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4800 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4801
4802 See also : "server"
4803
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004804
4805dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4806 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4807 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4808 yes | no | yes | yes
4809 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4810
4811 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004812 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004813 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4814 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004815 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004816 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004817
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004818enabled
4819 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4820 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4821 yes | yes | yes | yes
4822 Arguments : none
4823
4824 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4825 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4826
4827 See also : "disabled"
4828
4829
4830errorfile <code> <file>
4831 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4832 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4833 yes | yes | yes | yes
4834 Arguments :
4835 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004836 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004837 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004838
4839 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004840 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004841 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004842 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4843 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004844
4845 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4846 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4847 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4848
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004849 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4850
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004851 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4852 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4853 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4854 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4855 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4856 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4857 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4858 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4859 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004860
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004861 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4862 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4863 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004864 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004865 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4866
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004867 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004868
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004869 Example :
4870 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004871 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004872 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4873 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4874
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004875
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004876errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4877 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4878 section.
4879 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4880 yes | yes | yes | yes
4881 Arguments :
4882 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4883
4884 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004885 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004886 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4887 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004888
4889 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4890 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4891 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4892 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4893 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004894 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004895 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4896
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004897 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4898 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004899
4900 Example :
4901 errorfiles generic
4902 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4903
4904
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004905errorloc <code> <url>
4906errorloc302 <code> <url>
4907 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4908 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4909 yes | yes | yes | yes
4910 Arguments :
4911 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004912 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004913 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004914
4915 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4916 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4917 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4918 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004919 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4922 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4923 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4924
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004925 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4926
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004927 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4928 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4929 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4930 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004931 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004932 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4933 request.
4934
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004935 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004936
4937
4938errorloc303 <code> <url>
4939 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4941 yes | yes | yes | yes
4942 Arguments :
4943 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004944 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004945 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004946
4947 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4948 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4949 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4950 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004951 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004952
4953 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4954 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4955 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4956
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004957 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4958
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004959 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4960 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4961 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4962 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004963 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004964
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004965 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004966
4967
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004968email-alert from <emailaddr>
4969 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004970 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004971 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4972 yes | yes | yes | yes
4973
4974 Arguments :
4975
4976 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4977
4978 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4979 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4980
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004981 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004982 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4983 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004984
4985
4986email-alert level <level>
4987 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4988 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4989 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4990 yes | yes | yes | yes
4991
4992 Arguments :
4993
4994 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4995 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4996 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4997
4998 By default level is alert
4999
5000 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5001 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5002 for the proxy.
5003
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09005004 Alerts are sent when :
5005
5006 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
5007 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
5008 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
5009 is notice or lower
5010 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
5011 and a health check status update occurs
5012
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005013 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
5014 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005015 section 3.6 about mailers.
5016
5017
5018email-alert mailers <mailersect>
5019 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
5020 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5021 yes | yes | yes | yes
5022
5023 Arguments :
5024
5025 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5026
5027 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5028 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5029
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005030 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5031 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005032
5033
5034email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5035 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5036 mailers.
5037 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5038 yes | yes | yes | yes
5039
5040 Arguments :
5041
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005042 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005043
5044 By default the systems hostname is used.
5045
5046 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5047 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5048 for the proxy.
5049
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005050 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5051 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005052
5053
5054email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005055 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005056 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5057 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5058 yes | yes | yes | yes
5059
5060 Arguments :
5061
5062 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5063
5064 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5065 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5066
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005067 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005068 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5069
5070
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005071error-log-format <string>
5072 Specifies the log format string to use in case of connection error on the frontend side.
5073 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5074 yes | yes | yes | no
5075
5076 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for logs
5077 containing information related to errors, timeouts, retries redispatches or
5078 HTTP status code 5xx. This format will in short be used for every log line
5079 that would be concerned by the "log-separate-errors" option, including
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +01005080 connection errors described in section 8.2.5.
5081
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02005082 If the directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will
5083 use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
5084 string in depth.
5085
5086 "error-log-format" directive overrides previous "error-log-format"
5087 directives.
5088
5089
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005090force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5091 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5092 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005093 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005094
5095 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5096 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5097 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5098 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5099 marked down for maintenance operations.
5100
5101 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5102 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5103 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5104 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5105 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5106 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5107 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5108 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5109 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5110
5111 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5112 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5113 is used.
5114
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005115 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005116 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005117
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005118
5119filter <name> [param*]
5120 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5122 no | yes | yes | yes
5123 Arguments :
5124 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5125 referenced in section 9.
5126
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005127 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005128 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005129 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5130 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005131
5132 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5133 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5134
5135 Example:
5136 listen
5137 bind *:80
5138
5139 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5140 filter compression
5141 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5142
5143 compression algo gzip
5144 compression offload
5145
5146 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5147
5148 See also : section 9.
5149
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005150
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005151fullconn <conns>
5152 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5154 yes | no | yes | yes
5155 Arguments :
5156 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5157 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5158
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005159 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005160 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005161 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005162 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5163 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5164 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5165 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5166 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005167 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005168
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005169 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005170 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005171 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5172 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5173 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005174
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005175 Example :
5176 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5177 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5178 # connections.
5179 backend dynamic
5180 fullconn 10000
5181 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5182 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5183
5184 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5185
5186
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005187hash-balance-factor <factor>
5188 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5189 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5190 yes | no | no | yes
5191 Arguments :
5192 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5193 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005194 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005195
5196 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5197 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5198 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5199 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5200 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5201 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5202 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5203
5204 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5205 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5206 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5207 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5208 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5209
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005210 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5211 consistent hashing mechanism.
5212
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005213 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5214
5215
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005216hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005217 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5218 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5219 yes | no | yes | yes
5220 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005221 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5222 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005223
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005224 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5225 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5226 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5227 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5228 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5229 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5230 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5231 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5232 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5233 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005234
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005235 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5236 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5237 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5238 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5239 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5240 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5241 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5242 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5243 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5244 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5245 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5246 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5247 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005248 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5249 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005250
5251 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5252
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005253 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005254 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5255 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5256 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005257 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5258 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5259 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005260
5261 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5262 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005263 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5264 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5265 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5266 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5267
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005268 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005269 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5270 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5271 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5272 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5273 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5274 parameter.
5275
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005276 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5277 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5278 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5279 used on strings.
5280
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005281 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5282
5283 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5284 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5285 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5286 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5287 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5288 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5289 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5290 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5291 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5292 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5293 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5294 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005295
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005296 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5297 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5298 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005299
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005300 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005301
5302
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005303http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5304 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5305 ones).
5306
5307 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005308 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005309
5310 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5311 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5312 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5313 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5314 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5315 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5316
5317 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5318 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5319 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5320
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005321 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
5322 supported:
5323 - add-header <name> <fmt>
5324 - allow
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005325 - capture <sample> id <id>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005326 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
5327 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5328 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5329 - set-header <name> <fmt>
5330 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005331 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5332 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005333 - strict-mode { on | off }
5334 - unset-var(<var-name>)
5335
5336 The supported actions are described below.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005337
5338 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5339 instance.
5340
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005341 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
5342 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
5343 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
5344 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
5345 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
5346 a defaults section defining such rules.
5347
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005348 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5349 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5350 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5351
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005352 Example:
5353 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5354 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5355 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5356
5357http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5358
5359 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005360 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
5361 complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005362
Christopher Fauletba8f0632021-12-06 08:43:22 +01005363http-after-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5364
5365 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
5366 converts it to a string. Please refer to "http-response capture" for a
5367 complete description.
5368
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005369http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5370
5371 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01005372 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005373
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005374http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005375
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005376 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
5377 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005378
5379http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5380 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5381
5382 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5383
5384 Example:
5385 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5386
5387 # applied to:
5388 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5389
5390 # outputs:
5391 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5392
5393 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5394
5395http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5396 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5397
5398 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5399
5400 Example:
5401 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5402
5403 # applied to:
5404 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5405
5406 # outputs:
5407 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5408
5409http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5410
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005411 This does the same as "http-after-response add-header" except that the header
5412 name is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
5413 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
5414 external users.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005415
5416http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5417 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5418
5419 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +05005420 between 100 and 999. Please refer to "http-response set-status" for a complete
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005421 description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005423http-after-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5424http-after-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005425
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005426 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5427 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
5428 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005429
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005430http-after-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005431
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005432 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
5433 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005434
5435http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5436
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02005437 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
5438 about <var-name>.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005439
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005440
5441http-check comment <string>
5442 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5443 it fails.
5444 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5445 yes | no | yes | yes
5446
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005447 Arguments :
5448 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5449 rule fails.
5450
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005451 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5452 user-friendly error reporting.
5453
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005454 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005455 "http-check expect".
5456
5457
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005458http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5459 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005460 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005461 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5462 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5463 yes | no | yes | yes
5464
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005465 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005466 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5467
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005468 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005469 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005470
5471 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5472 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5473 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5474 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5475
5476 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5477
5478 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5479
5480 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5481
5482 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5483
5484 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5485
5486 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5487 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5488 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5489 is used.
5490
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005491 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5492 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5493 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5494 haproxy -vv.
5495
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005496 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5497
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005498 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5499 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5500 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5501 different ports or with different servers.
5502
5503 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5504 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5505 the port with a "http-check connect".
5506
5507 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5508 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5509 do.
5510
5511 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5512 unset-var or comment rules.
5513
5514 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005515 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5516 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5517 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5518 option httpchk
5519
5520 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005521 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005522 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005523 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005524 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005525 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005526
5527 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5528
5529 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005530
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005531
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005532http-check disable-on-404
5533 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5534 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005535 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005536 Arguments : none
5537
5538 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5539 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5540 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5541 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5542 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5543 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5544 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5545 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005546 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5547 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005548 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5549 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5550 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005551
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005552 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005553
5554
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005555http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005556 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5557 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5558 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005559 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005560 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005561 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005562
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005563 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005564 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5565
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005566 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5567 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5568 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5569 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5570 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5571 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5572 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5573 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5574 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5575 result is always conclusive.
5576
5577 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5578 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5579 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005580 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5581 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005582 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5583 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005584 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5585 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5586 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005587
5588 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5589 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005590 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5591 supported :
5592 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5593 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005594 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5595 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5596 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5597 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5598 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005599
5600 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5601 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005602 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5603 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5604 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5605 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005606 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5607
5608 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5609 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5610 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5611 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5612
5613 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5614 informational message reported in logs if an error
5615 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5616 log-format string.
5617
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005618 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005619 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5620 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005621 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5622 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5623 details on the supported keywords.
5624
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005625 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5626 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5627 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5628 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005629
5630 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5631 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5632 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5633 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5634 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5635
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005636 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5637 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5638 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5639 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5640 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5641 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5642 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005643
5644 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005645 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005646 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5647 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5648 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5649 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5650
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005651 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5652 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005653 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5654 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5655 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5656 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5657 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5658 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5659 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5660 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005661 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5662 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5663 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5664 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5665 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5666 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5667 insensitive on the header names.
5668
5669 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5670 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5671 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5672 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5673 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5674 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005675
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005676 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005677 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005678 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5679 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5680 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5681 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5682 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005683 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005684 trace).
5685
5686 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005687 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005688 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5689 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5690 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5691 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5692 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005693 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005694
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005695 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5696 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5697 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5698 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5699 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5700 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5701
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005702 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005703 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005704 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5705 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5706 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5707 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5708 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5709 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5710
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005711 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5712 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5713 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5714 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5715 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005716
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005717 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5718 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5719
5720 Examples :
5721 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005722 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005723
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005724 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5725 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5726
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005727 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005728 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005729
5730 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005731 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005732
5733 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005734 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005735
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005736 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005737 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005738
5739
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005740http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005741 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5742 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005743 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5744 health checks.
5745 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5746 yes | no | yes | yes
5747 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005748 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5749
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005750 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5751 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5752 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5753 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5754 to invent non-standard ones.
5755
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005756 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5757 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5758 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5759 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5760
5761 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5762 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5763 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5764 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005765
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005766 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005767 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005768 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005769 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5770 to add it.
5771
5772 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5773 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5774 to the log-format rules.
5775
5776 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5777 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5778 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005779
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005780 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5781 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5782 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5783 request.
5784
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005785 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5786 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5787 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005788 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5789 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5790 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5791 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005792 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005793
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005794 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005795 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5796 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005797
5798 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5799 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5800 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5801 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5802 configured request authority.
5803
5804 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5805 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005806
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005807 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005808
5809
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005810http-check send-state
5811 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5813 yes | no | yes | yes
5814 Arguments : none
5815
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005816 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005817 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005818 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5819 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5820 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005821
5822 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5823 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5824 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5825 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5826 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005827 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5828 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5829 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5830
5831 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5832 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5833 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5834
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005835 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5836 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5837 checked in multiple backends.
5838
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005839 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005840 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5841
5842 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5843 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5844 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5845 one fails.
5846
5847 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5848 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5849 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5850
5851 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5852 server's queue.
5853
5854 Example of a header received by the application server :
5855 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5856 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5857
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005858 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5859 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005860
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005861
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005862http-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
5863http-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005864 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005865 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5866 yes | no | yes | yes
5867
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005868 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005869 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5870 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5871 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5872 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5873 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5874 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5875 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5876 and '-'.
5877
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005878 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
5879 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05005880 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01005881 conditions.
5882
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005883 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5884
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005885 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
5886 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
5887
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005888 Examples :
5889 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02005890 http-check set-var-fmt(check.port) "name=%H"
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005891
5892
5893http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005894 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5896 yes | no | yes | yes
5897
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005898 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005899 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5900 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5901 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5902 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5903 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5904 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5905 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5906 and '-'.
5907
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005908 Examples :
5909 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005910
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005911
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005912http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5913 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5914 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5915 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5916 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5917 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5918 yes | yes | yes | yes
5919 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005920 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005921 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005922 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005923 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005924
5925 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5926 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5927 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5928 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5929
5930 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5931 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5932 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5933 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5934
5935 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5936 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5937 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5938 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5939 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5940 chroot is performed.
5941
5942 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5943 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5944 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5945 considered.
5946
5947 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5948 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5949 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5950 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5951 considered as a raw string.
5952
5953 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5954 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5955 "content-type".
5956
5957 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5958 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5959 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5960 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5961 evaluated as a log-format string.
5962
5963 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5964 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5965 argument to "content-type".
5966
5967 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5968 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5969 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5970 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5971
5972 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5973 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5974 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5975 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5976 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5977 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5978 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5979 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5980
5981 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5982 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5983 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5984
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005985 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5986 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5987 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5988 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5989 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5990
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005991 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5992 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5993
5994
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005995http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005996 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5997
5998 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02005999 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006000
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006001 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
6002 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
6003 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
6004 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
6005 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006006
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006007 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
6008 supported:
6009 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6010 - add-header <name> <fmt>
6011 - allow
6012 - auth [realm <realm>]
6013 - cache-use <name>
6014 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6015 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6016 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
6017 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
6018 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6019 - disable-l7-retry
6020 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6021 - early-hint <name> <fmt>
6022 - normalize-uri <normalizer>
6023 - redirect <rule>
6024 - reject
6025 - replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6026 - replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6027 - replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6028 - replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6029 - replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6030 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
6031 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
6032 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
6033 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
6034 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6035 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6036 - set-dst <expr>
6037 - set-dst-port <expr>
6038 - set-header <name> <fmt>
6039 - set-log-level <level>
6040 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6041 - set-mark <mark>
6042 - set-method <fmt>
6043 - set-nice <nice>
6044 - set-path <fmt>
6045 - set-pathq <fmt>
6046 - set-priority-class <expr>
6047 - set-priority-offset <expr>
6048 - set-query <fmt>
6049 - set-src <expr>
6050 - set-src-port <expr>
6051 - set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
6052 - set-tos <tos>
6053 - set-uri <fmt>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006054 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
6055 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006056 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6057 - silent-drop
6058 - strict-mode { on | off }
6059 - tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
6060 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
6061 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
6062 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
6063 - unset-var(<var-name>)
6064 - use-service <service-name>
6065 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6066 - wait-for-handshake
6067 - cache-use <name>
6068
6069 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006072
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02006073 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
6074 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
6075 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
6076 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
6077 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
6078 a defaults section defining such rules.
6079
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006080 Example:
6081 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
6082 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
6083 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006084
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006085 http-request allow if nagios
6086 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6087 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6088 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006089
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006090 Example:
6091 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6092 acl add path /addacl
6093 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006094
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006095 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006096
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006097 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6098 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006099
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006100 Example:
6101 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6102 acl setmap path /setmap
6103 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006104
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006105 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006106
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006107 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6108 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006109
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006110 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6111 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006112
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006113http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006114
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006115 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6116 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6117 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6118 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6119 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6120 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6121 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6122 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006123
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006124http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006125
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006126 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6127 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6128 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6129 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6130 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6131 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6132 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6133 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006135http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006137 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +01006138 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006139
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006140http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006141
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006142 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6143 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6144 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6145 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6146 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006147
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006148 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6149 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6150 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6151 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6152 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6153 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6154 instead.
6155
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006156 Example:
6157 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6158 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006159
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006160http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006161
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006162 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006163
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006164http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6165 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006166
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006167 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6168 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6169 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6170 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6171 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6172 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6173 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6174 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6175 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006176
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006177 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6178 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6179 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006180 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6181
6182 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6183 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6184 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6185 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006186
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006187http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006188
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006189 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6190 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6191 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6192 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6193 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6194 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006195
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006196http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006197
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006198 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6199 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6200 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6201 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6202 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006203
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006204http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006205
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006206 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6207 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6208 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6209 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6210 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6211 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006212
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006213http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6214http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6215 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6216 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6217 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6218 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006219
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006220 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6221 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6222 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006223 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006224 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6225 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6226 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006227 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006228 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006229
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006230http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6231 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6232 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6233 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6234
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006235http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
6236 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006237
6238 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6239 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6240 pointed by <resolvers>.
6241 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6242 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6243 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6244 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6245 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6246 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6247 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6248 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6249 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6250 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
6251 to 0.0.0.0.
6252
6253 Example:
6254 resolvers mydns
6255 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6256 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6257 timeout retry 1s
6258 hold valid 10s
6259 hold nx 3s
6260 hold other 3s
6261 hold obsolete 0s
6262 accepted_payload_size 8192
6263
6264 frontend fe
6265 bind 10.42.0.1:80
6266 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower
6267 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6268
6269 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6270 # which mean DNS resolution error
6271 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6272
6273 default_backend be
6274
6275 backend b_503
6276 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6277 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6278 # 503 error page to end users
6279
6280 backend be
6281 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6282 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6283 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6284 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6285 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6286
6287 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6288 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6289
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006290http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6291
6292 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6293 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6294 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6295 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006296 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6297 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006298
6299 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6300
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006301http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006302http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006303http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006304http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006305http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006306http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006307http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006308http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6309http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006310
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006311 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6312
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006313 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006314 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6315 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6316 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6317 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006318
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006319 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6320 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6321 the supported backend.
6322
6323 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6324 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6325 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6326 number of segments in the path.
6327
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006328 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6329 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6330 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6331 when improperly combined.
6332
6333 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6334 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6335 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6336 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6337 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6338
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006339 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006340
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006341 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6342
6343 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6344 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6345
6346 Example:
6347 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6348
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006349 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6350
6351 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6352 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6353
6354 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6355 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6356
6357 Example:
6358 - /#foo -> /
6359
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006360 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6361 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006362
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006363 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6364 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6365
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006366 Example:
6367 - /. -> /
6368 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6369 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6370 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006371
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006372 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6373 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6374
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006375 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006376 their preceding segment.
6377
6378 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6379 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6380
6381 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6382 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006383
6384 Example:
6385 - /foo/../ -> /
6386 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6387 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6388 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006389 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006390 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006391 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006392
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006393 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6394 removed as well:
6395
6396 Example:
6397 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6398 - /bar/../../ -> /
6399
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006400 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6401 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006402
6403 Example:
6404 - // -> /
6405 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6406
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006407 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6408 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6409
6410 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6411 ".", "_", and "~".
6412
6413 Example:
6414 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6415 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6416 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6417 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6418
6419 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6420 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6421
6422 Example:
6423 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6424 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6425
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006426 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006427 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006428
6429 Example:
6430 - /%6f -> /%6F
6431 - /%zz -> /%zz
6432
6433 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6434 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6435
6436 Example:
6437 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6438
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006439 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006440 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6441 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6442
6443 Example:
6444 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6445 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6446 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6447
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006448http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006449
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006450 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6451 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6452 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6453 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6454 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006455
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006456http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006457
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006458 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6459 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6460 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6461 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006462
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006463http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6464 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006465
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006466 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006467 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6468 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6469 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6470 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6471 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006472
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006473 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6474 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6475 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6476 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6477 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006478
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006479 Example:
6480 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6481
6482 # applied to:
6483 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6484
6485 # outputs:
6486 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6487
6488 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006489
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006490 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6491
6492 # applied to:
6493 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006494
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006495 # outputs:
6496 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006497
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006498http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6499 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6500
6501 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6502 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006503 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6504 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6505 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006506
6507 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6508 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6509 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6510
6511 Example:
6512 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6513 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6514
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006515 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6516 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6517 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6518 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6519
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006520http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6521 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6522
6523 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6524 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6525 query-string are replaced.
6526
6527 Example:
6528 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6529 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6530
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006531http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6532 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6533
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006534 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6535 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6536 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6537 against.
6538
6539 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6540 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6541 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006542
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006543 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6544 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6545 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6546 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6547 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6548 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6549 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6550 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6551 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006552 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6553 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006554
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006555 Example:
6556 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6557 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006558
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006559 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6560 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006561
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006562http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6563 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006564
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006565 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6566 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6567 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6568 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006569
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006570 Example:
6571 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006572
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006573 # applied to:
6574 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006575
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006576 # outputs:
6577 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006578
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006579http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6580 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6581 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006582 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006583 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6584
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006585 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006586 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6587 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006588 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006589 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006590 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006591 are followed to create the response :
6592
6593 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6594 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6595 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6596 ignored.
6597
6598 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6599 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006600 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006601 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6602 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006603
6604 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6605 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6606 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006607 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006608 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006609
6610 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6611 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6612 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006613 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006614 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006615 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006616
6617 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6618 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6619 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6620 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6621 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6622 as a raw content.
6623
6624 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6625 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6626 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6627 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6628 considered as a raw string.
6629
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006630 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006631 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6632 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6633 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6634
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006635 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6636 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006637 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006638
6639 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6640
6641 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006642 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006643 if { path /ping }
6644
6645 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6646 if { path /favicon.ico }
6647
6648 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6649 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6650 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6651
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02006652http-request sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6653
6654 This actions increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
6655 of the array associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id>.
6656 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6657 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6658 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPC stored
6659 at this index.
6660 This action applies only to the 'gpc' and 'gpc_rate' array data_types (and
6661 not to the legacy 'gpc0', 'gpc1', 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
6662
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006663http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6664http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006665
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006666 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6667 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6668 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006669
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02006670http-request sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6671 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6672 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT at the index <idx> of the array
6673 associated to the sticky counter designated by <sc-id> at the value of
6674 <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a boolean.
6675 If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
6676 continues. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <sc-id> is an integer
6677 between 0 and 2. It also silently fails if the there is no GPT stored
6678 at this index.
6679 This action applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not to the
6680 legacy 'gpt0' data-type).
6681
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006682http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6683 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006684
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006685 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6686 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6687 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6688 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006689
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02006690http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6691 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6692
6693 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6694 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6695 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6696 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6697 agent name must be used.
6698
6699 Arguments:
6700 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6701
6702 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6703 configuration.
6704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006707 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6708 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6709 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6710 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6711 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006713 Arguments:
6714 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6715 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006716
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006717 Example:
6718 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6719 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006720
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006721 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6722 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006723
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006724http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006725
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006726 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6727 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6728 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006729
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006730 Arguments:
6731 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6732 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006733
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006734 Example:
6735 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6736 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006737
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006738 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6739 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6740 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006741
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006742http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006743
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006744 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6745 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6746 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6747 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6748 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006749
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006750 Example:
6751 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6752 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6753 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6754 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6755 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6756 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6757 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6758 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6759 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006760
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006761http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006762
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006763 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6764 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6765 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6766 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6767 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006768
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006769http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6770 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006771
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006772 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6773 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6774 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6775 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6776 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6777 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6778 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6779 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6780 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006781
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006782http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006783
David Carlierf7f53af2021-06-26 12:04:36 +01006784 This is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK on all packets sent to the client
6785 to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6786 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter/ipfw and by the
6787 routing table or monitoring the packets through DTrace. It can be expressed
6788 both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x").
6789 This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route (for
6790 example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
David Carlierbae4cb22021-07-03 10:15:15 +01006791 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges, as well on FreeBSD
6792 and OpenBSD.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006793
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006794http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006795
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006796 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6797 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6798 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006799
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006800http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006802 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6803 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6804 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6805 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6806 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6807 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6808 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6809 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006810
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006811http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006812
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006813 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6814 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6815 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6816 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6817 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6818 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006819
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006820 Example :
6821 # prepend the host name before the path
6822 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006823
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006824http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6825
6826 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6827 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6828 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6829
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006830http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006831
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006832 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6833 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6834 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6835 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6836 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006837
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006838http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006839
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006840 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6841 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6842 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6843 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6844 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6845 values have higher priority.
6846 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6847 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6848 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6849 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6850 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006853
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006854 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6855 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6856 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6857 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6858 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6859 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6860 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006861
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006862 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006863
6864 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006865 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6866 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006867
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006868http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6869 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6870 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6871 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006872 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6873 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006874
6875 Arguments :
6876 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6877 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006878
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006879 See also "option forwardfor".
6880
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006881 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006882 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6883 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6884
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006885 # After the masking this will track connections
6886 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6887 http-request track-sc0 src
6888
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006889 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6890 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6891
6892http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6893
6894 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6895 expression.
6896
6897 Arguments:
6898 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6899 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006900
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006901 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006902 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6903 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6904
6905 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6906 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6907 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6908
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006909http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006910 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6911
6912 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6913 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6914 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6915 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6916 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6917
6918 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6919 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6920 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6921 results.
6922
6923 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006924 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6925 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006926
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006927http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6928
6929 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6930 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6931 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6932 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6933 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6934 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6935 information from the request.
6936
6937 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6938
6939http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6940
6941 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6942 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6943 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6944 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6945 path and the query string.
6946 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6947
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006948http-request set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6949http-request set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006950
6951 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6952 inline.
6953
6954 Arguments:
6955 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6956 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6957 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6958 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6959 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6960 (request and response)
6961 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6962 processing
6963 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6964 processing
6965 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6966 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6967 and '_'.
6968
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006969 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
6970 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +05006971 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01006972 conditions.
6973
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006974 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6975 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006976
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006977 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
6978 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
6979
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006980 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006981 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +02006982 http-request set-var-fmt(txn.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
6983
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006984http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6985
6986 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6987 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6988 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6989 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6990 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6991 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6992 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6993 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6994 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6995 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6996 action.
6997 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6998 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6999 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7000 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7001 you fully understand how it works.
7002
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007003http-request strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007004
7005 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7006 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7007 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7008 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7009 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007010 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007011 processing.
7012
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007013 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007014 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
7015 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
7016 rules evaluation.
7017
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007018http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7019http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7020 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7021 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7022 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7023 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007024
7025 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
7026 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
7027 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007028 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
7029 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
7030 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
7031 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
7032 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
7033 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007034 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007035 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
7036 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
7037 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007038 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007039 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
7040 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
7041 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
7042 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7043 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007044
7045http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7046http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7047http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7048
7049 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
7050 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
7051 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
7052 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02007053 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007054 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7055 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
7056 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
7057 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
7058 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
7059 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
7060 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
7061
7062 Arguments :
7063 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
7064 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
7065 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
7066 select which table entry to update the counters.
7067
7068 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
7069 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
7070 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
7071 that table until the session ends.
7072
7073 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
7074 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
7075 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
7076 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
7077 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
7078 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
7079 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
7080 useful information.
7081
7082 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
7083 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
7084 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
7085 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
7086 checks that make use of it.
7087
7088http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7089
7090 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007091
7092 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007093 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007094
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01007095http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7096
7097 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
7098 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
7099 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
7100 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
7101 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
7102 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
7103
7104 Arguments :
7105 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
7106
7107 Example:
7108 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
7109
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007110http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7111 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7112
7113 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
7114 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7115 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7116 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7117 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
7118 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
7119 http-buffer-request".
7120
7121 Arguments :
7122
7123 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7124 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7125
7126 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007127 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007128 bytes.
7129
7130 Example:
7131 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7132
7133 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7134
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007135http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007136
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007137 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7138 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7139 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007140
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007141
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007142http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007143 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7144
7145 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007146 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007147
7148 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7149 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7150 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7151 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7152 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7153 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7154
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007155 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
7156 supported:
7157 - add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7158 - add-header <name> <fmt>
7159 - allow
7160 - cache-store <name>
7161 - capture <sample> id <id>
7162 - del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7163 - del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ]
7164 - del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt>
7165 - deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] ...
7166 - redirect <rule>
7167 - replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7168 - replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7169 - return [status <code>] [content-type <type>] ...
7170 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
7171 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
7172 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
7173 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7174 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7175 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7176 - set-header <name> <fmt>
7177 - set-log-level <level>
7178 - set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7179 - set-mark <mark>
7180 - set-nice <nice>
7181 - set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7182 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007183 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
7184 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007185 - silent-drop
7186 - strict-mode { on | off }
7187 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
7188 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
7189 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
7190 - unset-var(<var-name>)
7191 - wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7192
7193 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007194
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007195 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007196
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +02007197 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
7198 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
7199 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
7200 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
7201 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
7202 a defaults section defining such rules.
7203
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007204 Example:
7205 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007206
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007207 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007208
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007209 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7210 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007211
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007212 Example:
7213 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007214
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007215 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007216
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007217 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7218 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007219
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007220 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7221 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007222
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007223http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007224
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007225 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7226 add-acl" for a complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007227
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007228http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007229
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007230 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007231 value is defined by <fmt>. Please refer to "http-request add-header" for a
7232 complete description.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007233
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007234http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007235
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007236 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7237 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007238
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007239http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007240
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007241 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007242
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007243http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007244
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007245 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7246 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7247 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7248 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7249 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7250 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7251 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007252
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007253 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7254 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7255 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7256 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7257 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007258
7259 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7260 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7261 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7262 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007263
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007264http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007265
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007266 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. Please refer to "http-request
7267 del-acl" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007268
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007269http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007270
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007271 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. Please
7272 refer to "http-request del-header" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007273
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007274http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007275
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007276 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7277 del-map" for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007278
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007279http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7280http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7281 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7282 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7283 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7284 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007285
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007286 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7287 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7288 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007289 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007290 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7291 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7292 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007293 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007294 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007296http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007297
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007298 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7299 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7300 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7301 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7302 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7303 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007304
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007305http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7306 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007307
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007308 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7309 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007310
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007311 Example:
7312 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007313
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007314 # applied to:
7315 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007316
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007317 # outputs:
7318 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007319
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007320 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007321
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007322http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7323 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007324
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007325 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007326 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007327
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007328 Example:
7329 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007330
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007331 # applied to:
7332 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007333
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007334 # outputs:
7335 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007336
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007337http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7338 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7339 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007340 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007341 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7342
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007343 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a
7344 response. Please refer to "http-request return" for a complete
7345 description. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007346
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +02007347http-response sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007348http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7349http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007350
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007351 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
7352 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
7353 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
7354 description.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007355
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +02007356http-response sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007357 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007358http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7359 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007360http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7361 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007362
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007363 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
7364 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
7365 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007366
Christopher Faulet24e7f352021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007367http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7368 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007369
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007370 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
7371 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007372
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007373http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007374
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007375 This does the same as "http-response add-header" except that the header name
7376 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
7377 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
7378 external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007379
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007380http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7381
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007382 This is used to change the log level of the current response. Please refer to
7383 "http-request set-log-level" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007384
7385http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7386
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007387 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. Please refer to "http-request
7388 set-map" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007389
7390http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7391
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007392 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
7393 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
7394 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007395
7396http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7397
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007398 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
7399 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007400
7401http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7402 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7403
7404 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7405 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7406 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7407 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007408
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007409 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007410 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7411 http-response set-status 431
7412 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7413 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007414
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007415http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007416
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007417 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007418 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
7419 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007420
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +01007421http-response set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7422http-response set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007423
7424 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007425 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
7426 for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007427
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007428http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007429
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007430 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7431 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007432 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
7433 complete description.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007434
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007435http-response strict-mode { on | off } [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007436
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007437 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following
7438 rules. Please refer to "http-request strict-mode" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007439
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007440http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7441http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7442http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007443
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007444 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
7445 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
7446 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007447
7448http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7449
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007450 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-request set-var" for details
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007451 about <var-name>.
7452
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007453http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7454 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7455
7456 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +02007457 most <time> milliseconds. Please refer to "http-request wait-for-body" for a
7458 complete description.
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007459
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007460
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007461http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7462 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7463
7464 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7465 yes | no | yes | yes
7466
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007467 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007468 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7469 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7470 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007471
7472 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7473
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007474 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7475 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7476 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7477 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7478 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7479 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7480 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007481 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007482 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7483 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007484
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007485 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7486 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7487 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7488 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7489 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7490 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7491 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007492 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7493 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7494 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7495 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7496 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7497 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007498
7499 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7500 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7501 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7502 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7503 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7504 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7505 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7506 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007507 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007508 downsides of rare connection failures.
7509
7510 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7511 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7512 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7513 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7514 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7515 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007516 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007517 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7518 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7519 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7520 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7521 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7522
7523 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007524 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7525 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7526 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7527 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007528
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007529 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7530 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007531
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007532 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007533
7534 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7535 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7536 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7537
7538 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7539
7540
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007541http-send-name-header [<header>]
7542 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007543 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7544 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007545 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007546 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7547
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007548 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7549 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7550 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7551 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7552 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7553 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7554 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7555 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7556 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7557 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7558 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7559 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7560 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7561 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7562 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7563 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007564
7565 See also : "server"
7566
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007567id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007568 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7570 no | yes | yes | yes
7571 Arguments : none
7572
7573 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7574 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7575 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007576
7577
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007578ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7579 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7580 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007581 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007582
7583 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7584 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7585 and running).
7586
7587 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7588 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7589 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007590 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007591 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7592
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007593 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7594 "unless" condition is met.
7595
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007596 Example:
7597 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7598 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7599 ignore-persist if url_static
7600
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007601 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7602
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007603load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7604 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7605 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7606 yes | no | yes | yes
7607
7608 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7609 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7610 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007611 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007612 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007613 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7614 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7615 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7616
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007617 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007618 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007619 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007620
7621 Arguments:
7622 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7623 named "server-state-file".
7624
7625 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7626 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7627 name is used as a file name.
7628
7629 none don't load any stat for this backend
7630
7631 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007632 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7633 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7634 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007635 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007636 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007637
7638 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7639 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7640
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007641 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007642
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007643 global
7644 stats socket /tmp/socket
7645 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007646
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007647 defaults
7648 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007649
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007650 backend bk
7651 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7652 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007653
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007654
7655 Then one can run :
7656
7657 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7658
7659 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7660
7661 1
7662 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7663 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7664 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7665
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007666 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007667
7668 global
7669 stats socket /tmp/socket
7670 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7671
7672 defaults
7673 load-server-state-from-file local
7674
7675 backend bk
7676 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7677 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7678
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007679
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007680 Then one can run :
7681
7682 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7683
7684 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7685
7686 1
7687 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7688 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7689 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7690
7691 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7692 "show servers state"
7693
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007694
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007695log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007696log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007697 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007698no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007699 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7700 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7701 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007702
7703 Prefix :
7704 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7705 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7706 prefix does not allow arguments.
7707
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007708 Arguments :
7709 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7710 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7711 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7712 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7713 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7714 parameter.
7715
7716 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7717 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7718
7719 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7720 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7721 standard syslog port).
7722
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007723 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7724 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7725 standard syslog port).
7726
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007727 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7728 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7729 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007730 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007731
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007732 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7733 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7734 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7735 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7736 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7737 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7738 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7739 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7740 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7741 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7742 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7743 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007744 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007745 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7746 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7747 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007748 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7749 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007750
7751 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7752 and "fd@2", see above.
7753
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007754 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7755 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7756 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7757 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7758 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7759 having the logs instantly available.
7760
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007761 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7762 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7763 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7764
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007765 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7766 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007767
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007768 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7769 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7770 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7771 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7772 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7773 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7774 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7775 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7776 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7777 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007778 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007779
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007780 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7781 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7782 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7783 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7784 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7785
7786 <sample_size>
7787 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7788 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7789 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7790 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7791 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7792
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007793 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7794 one of the following :
7795
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007796 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7797 field is stripped. This is the default.
7798 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7799 rfc3164.
7800
7801 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007802 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7803
7804 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7805 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7806
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007807 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7808 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7809 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7810 designed to be used with a local log server.
7811
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007812 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7813 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7814 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7815 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7816 systemd logger consumes.
7817
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007818 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7819 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7820 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7821 used with a local log server.
7822
7823 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7824 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7825 designed to be used with a local log server.
7826
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007827 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7828 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7829 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7830 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7831
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007832 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7833
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007834 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7835 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7836 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7837
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007838 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7839 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7840 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7841 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007842
7843 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7844 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7845 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007846 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7847 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7848 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7849 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7850 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007851
7852 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7853
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007854 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7855 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7856 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007857
7858 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7859 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7860 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7861 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7862
7863 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7864 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007865
7866 Example :
7867 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007868 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7869 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7870 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007871 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007872 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7873 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007874 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007875
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007876
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007877log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007878 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7879 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7880 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007881
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007882 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7883 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7884 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7885 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7886 string in depth.
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonfe21fe72021-08-31 12:08:52 +02007887 A specific log-format used only in case of connection error can also be
7888 defined, see the "error-log-format" option.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007889
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02007890 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format",
7891 "option httplog" and "option httpslog" directives.
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007892
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007893log-format-sd <string>
7894 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7895 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7896 yes | yes | yes | no
7897
7898 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7899 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7900 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7901 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7902 which covers the log format string in depth.
7903
7904 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7905 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7906
7907 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7908 log format to "rfc5424".
7909
7910 Example :
7911 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7912
7913
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007914log-tag <string>
7915 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7916 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7917 yes | yes | yes | yes
7918
7919 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7920 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007921 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007922 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7923 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7924 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7925 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7926 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7927 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007928
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007929max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7930 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7931 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7932 yes | no | yes | yes
7933
7934 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7935 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7936 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7937 servers.
7938
7939 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007940 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007941 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7942 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7943 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007944 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007945 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7946 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7947 picking a different server.
7948
7949 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7950 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7951 even if they have to be queued.
7952
7953 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7954 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7955
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007956max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7957 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7958 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7959 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007960
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007961maxconn <conns>
7962 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7963 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7964 yes | yes | yes | no
7965 Arguments :
7966 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7967 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7968 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7969 closes.
7970
7971 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007972 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007973 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7974 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007975 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7976 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7977 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7978 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007979
7980 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7981 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7982 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7983
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007984 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7985 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007986
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007987 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7988
7989
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007990mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007991 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7993 yes | yes | yes | yes
7994 Arguments :
7995 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
7996 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
7997 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
7998 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
7999
8000 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8001 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8002 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8003 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8004 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8005
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008006 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8007 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8008 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008009
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008010 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008011 defaults http_instances
8012 mode http
8013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008014
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008015monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008016 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008017 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8018 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008019 Arguments :
8020 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8021 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008022 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008023 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8024 backend and its backup.
8025
8026 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8027 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8028 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8029 servers in a list of backends.
8030
8031 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8032 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8033 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008034 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008035 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8036 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008037 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008038 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8039 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008040
8041 Example:
8042 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008043 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008044 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8045 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8046 monitor-uri /site_alive
8047 monitor fail if site_dead
8048
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008049 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008050
8051
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008052monitor-uri <uri>
8053 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8054 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8055 yes | yes | yes | no
8056 Arguments :
8057 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8058 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8059
8060 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8061 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8062 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8063 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8064 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8065 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8066 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8067 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8068
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008069 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008070 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8071 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8072 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8073 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8074 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8075 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008076
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008077 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8078 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8079 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8080 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8081
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008082 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008083 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008084 frontend www
8085 mode http
8086 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8087
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008088 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008089
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008090
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008091option abortonclose
8092no option abortonclose
8093 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8094 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8095 yes | no | yes | yes
8096 Arguments : none
8097
8098 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8099 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8100 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8101 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008102 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008103 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8104 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8105 encountered while delivering the response.
8106
8107 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8108 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8109 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8110 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8111 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8112 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008113 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008114 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008115 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008116 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8117 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8118 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8119
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008120 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8121 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008122 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8123 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8124 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8125 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8126 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8127 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008128 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008129
8130 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8131 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8132
8133 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8134
8135
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008136option accept-invalid-http-request
8137no option accept-invalid-http-request
8138 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8140 yes | yes | yes | no
8141 Arguments : none
8142
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008143 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008144 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008145 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008146 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8147 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8148 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8149 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8150 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008151 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8152 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8153 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8154 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008155 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008156 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008157 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8158 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8159 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008160
8161 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8162 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8163 been confirmed.
8164
8165 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8166 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008167 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8168 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008169 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8170
8171 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8172 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8173
8174 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8175 stats socket.
8176
8177
8178option accept-invalid-http-response
8179no option accept-invalid-http-response
8180 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8181 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8182 yes | no | yes | yes
8183 Arguments : none
8184
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008185 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008186 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008187 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008188 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8189 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8190 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8191 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8192 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008193 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8194 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8195 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008196
8197 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8198 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8199 been confirmed.
8200
8201 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8202 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8203 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8204 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8205
8206 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8207 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8208
8209 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8210 stats socket.
8211
8212
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008213option allbackups
8214no option allbackups
8215 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8216 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8217 yes | no | yes | yes
8218 Arguments : none
8219
8220 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8221 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8222 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8223 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8224 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8225 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8226 order between the backup servers anymore.
8227
8228 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8229 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8230
8231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8233
8234
8235option checkcache
8236no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008237 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8239 yes | no | yes | yes
8240 Arguments : none
8241
8242 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8243 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008244 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008245 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8246 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008247 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008248
8249 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008250 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008251 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008252 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8253 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008254 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008255 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008256 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8257 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008258 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008259 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8260 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008261 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008262 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8263 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8264 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8265 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8266 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8267 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8268 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8269 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8270 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8271
8272 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008273 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8274 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8275 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8276 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008277
8278 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8279 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008280 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008281 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008282
8283 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8284 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8285
8286
8287option clitcpka
8288no option clitcpka
8289 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8290 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8291 yes | yes | yes | no
8292 Arguments : none
8293
8294 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8295 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008296 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008297 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8298
8299 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8300 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8301 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8302 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8303
8304 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8305 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8306 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8307 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8308 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8309
8310 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8311
8312 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8313 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8314 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8315
8316 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8317 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8318
8319 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8320
8321
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008322option contstats
8323 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8324 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8325 yes | yes | yes | no
8326 Arguments : none
8327
8328 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8329 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8330 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008331 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008332 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8333 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8334 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8335 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8336 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008337
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008338option disable-h2-upgrade
8339no option disable-h2-upgrade
8340 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8341 connection.
8342 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8343 yes | yes | yes | no
8344 Arguments : none
8345
8346 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8347 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8348 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8349 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008350 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8351 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8352 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8353 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8354 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8355 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008356
8357 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8358 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008359
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008360option dontlog-normal
8361no option dontlog-normal
8362 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8363 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8364 yes | yes | yes | no
8365 Arguments : none
8366
8367 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8368 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8369 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8370 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8371 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8372 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8373 logged.
8374
8375 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8376 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8377 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8378
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008379 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008380 logging.
8381
8382
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008383option dontlognull
8384no option dontlognull
8385 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8386 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8387 yes | yes | yes | no
8388 Arguments : none
8389
8390 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8391 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8392 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8393 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8394 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8395 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008396 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8397 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8398 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008399
8400 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008401 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008402 would not be logged.
8403
8404 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8405 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8406
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008407 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008408 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008409
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008410
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008411option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008412 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8414 yes | yes | yes | yes
8415 Arguments :
8416 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8417 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008418 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008419 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008420
8421 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8422 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8423 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8424 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8425 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8426 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8427 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008428 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8429 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8430 possible that the client has already brought one.
8431
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008432 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008433 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008434 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008435 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008436 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008437 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008438
8439 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8440 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8441 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8442 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8443 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8444 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008445 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008446
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008447 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8448 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008449 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008450 are under the control of the end-user.
8451
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008452 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008453 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8454 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008455 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8456 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8457 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008458
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008459 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008460 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8461 frontend www
8462 mode http
8463 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8464
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008465 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8466 backend www
8467 mode http
8468 option forwardfor header X-Client
8469
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008470 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008471 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008472
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008473
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008474option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8475no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8476 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8477 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8478 yes | yes | yes | no
8479 Arguments : none
8480
8481 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8482 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8483 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8484 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8485 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8486 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8487 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8488
8489 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8490 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8491 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8492 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8493 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8494 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8495 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8496 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8497 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8498 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8499
8500 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8501
8502 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8503 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8504
8505 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8506 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8507
8508
8509option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8510no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8511 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8513 yes | no | yes | yes
8514 Arguments : none
8515
8516 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8517 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8518 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8519 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8520 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8521 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8522 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8523
8524 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8525 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8526 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8527 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8528 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8529 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8530 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8531 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8532 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8533 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8534
8535 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8536
8537 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8538 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8539
8540 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8541 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8542
8543
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008544option http-buffer-request
8545no option http-buffer-request
8546 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8547 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8548 yes | yes | yes | yes
8549 Arguments : none
8550
8551 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8552 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8553 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8554 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8555 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8556 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008557 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8558 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8559 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8560 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008561
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008562 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8563 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008564
8565
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008566option http-ignore-probes
8567no option http-ignore-probes
8568 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8569 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8570 yes | yes | yes | no
8571 Arguments : none
8572
8573 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8574 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8575 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8576 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8577 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8578 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8579 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8580 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8581 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008582 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8583 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008584 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8585
8586 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8587 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8588 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8589 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8590 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8591 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8592 are often the only way to detect them.
8593
8594 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8595 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8596
8597 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8598
8599
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008600option http-keep-alive
8601no option http-keep-alive
8602 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8604 yes | yes | yes | yes
8605 Arguments : none
8606
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008607 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8608 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008609 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8610 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008611 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8612 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8613 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008614
8615 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8616 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008617 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8618 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8619 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8620 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8621 situations where this option may be useful :
8622
8623 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008624 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008625
8626 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8627 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8628
8629 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8630 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8631 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8632 request.
8633
8634 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8635 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008636 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8637 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8638 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008639
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008640 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8641 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8642 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8643 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8644 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8645 not set.
8646
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008647 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8648 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8649 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008650
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008651 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008652 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008653 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008654
8655
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008656option http-no-delay
8657no option http-no-delay
8658 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8659 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8660 yes | yes | yes | yes
8661 Arguments : none
8662
8663 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8664 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8665 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8666 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8667 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8668 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8669 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008670 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008671 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8672 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8673 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8674 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8675 affected.
8676
8677 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8678 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8679 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8680 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8681 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8682 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8683 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8684 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8685 latency environments.
8686
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008687 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8688
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008689
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008690option http-pretend-keepalive
8691no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008692 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008693 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008694 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008695 Arguments : none
8696
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008697 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008698 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8699 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8700 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008701 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008702 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8703 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8704 consider the response complete.
8705
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008706 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008707 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008708 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008709 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008710 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008711 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8712
8713 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8714 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8715 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8716 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008717 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8718 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008719 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8720
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008721 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8722 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8723 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8724 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8725 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8726 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008727
8728 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8729 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8730
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008731 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008732 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008733
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008734
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008735option http-server-close
8736no option http-server-close
8737 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8738 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8739 yes | yes | yes | yes
8740 Arguments : none
8741
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008742 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8743 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8744 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8745 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008746 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8747 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8748 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8749 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8750 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8751 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8752 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8753 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8754 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8755 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8756 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008757
8758 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8759 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8760 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8761 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008762 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8763 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008764
8765 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8766 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008767 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8768 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8769 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008770
8771 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8772 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8773
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008774 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8775 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008776
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008777option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008778no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008779 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8781 yes | yes | yes | no
8782 Arguments : none
8783
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008784 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008785 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8786 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8787 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8788 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8789 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008790 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008791
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008792 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008793 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008794 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8795 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8796 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008797
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008798 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8799 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8800 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8801 front of an existing proxy.
8802
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008803 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8804
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008805 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008806
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008807option httpchk
8808option httpchk <uri>
8809option httpchk <method> <uri>
8810option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008811 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 yes | no | yes | yes
8814 Arguments :
8815 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8816 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8817 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8818 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8819 ones.
8820
8821 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8822 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8823 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8824
8825 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8826 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8827 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008828 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008829
8830 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8831 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8832 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8833 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8834 the lack of any response.
8835
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008836 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8837 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8838 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8839 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8840
8841 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8842 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8843 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008844
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008845 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8846 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008847 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008848 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008849 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008850
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008851 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8852 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8853 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8854 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8855
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008856 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008857 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8858 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8859 backend https_relay
8860 mode tcp
8861 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8862 http-check send hdr Host www
8863 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008864
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008865 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8866 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8867 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008868
8869
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008870option httpclose
8871no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008872 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8874 yes | yes | yes | yes
8875 Arguments : none
8876
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008877 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8878 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8879 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8880 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008881 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008882
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008883 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8884 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008885 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008886 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8887 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008888
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008889 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8890 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8891 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008892
8893 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8894 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008895 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8896 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8897 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008898
8899 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8900 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8901
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008902 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008903
8904
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008905option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008906 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8907 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008908 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008909 Arguments :
8910 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8911 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8912 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008913 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008914 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008915
8916 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8917 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8918 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8919 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8920 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8921 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8922 ports.
8923
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008924 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8925 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008926
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008927 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8928
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008929 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008930
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +02008931option httpslog
8932 Enable logging of HTTPS request, session state and timers
8933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8934 yes | yes | yes | no
8935
8936 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8937 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8938 "option httpslog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8939 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8940 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8941 frontend, backend and server name, the SSL certificate verification and SSL
8942 handshake statuses, and of course the source address and ports.
8943
8944 "option httpslog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8945
8946 See also : section 8 about logging.
8947
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008948
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008949option independent-streams
8950no option independent-streams
8951 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008952 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8953 yes | yes | yes | yes
8954 Arguments : none
8955
8956 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
8957 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
8958 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
8959 receive data or not.
8960
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008961 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008962 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
8963 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
8964 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
8965 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
8966 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
8967 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
8968 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
8969 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
8970 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
8971 socket buffers.
8972
8973 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
8974 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
8975 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
8976 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
8977 slow lines, so use it with caution.
8978
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02008979 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008980
8981
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02008982option ldap-check
8983 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
8984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8985 yes | no | yes | yes
8986 Arguments : none
8987
8988 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
8989 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
8990 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
8991 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
8992
8993 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
8994 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
8995
8996 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
8997 configure it.
8998
8999 Example :
9000 option ldap-check
9001
9002 See also : "option httpchk"
9003
9004
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009005option external-check
9006 Use external processes for server health checks
9007 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9008 yes | no | yes | yes
9009
9010 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9011 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9012 command".
9013
9014 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9015
9016 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9017
9018
William Dauchya9dd9012022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009019option idle-close-on-response
9020no option idle-close-on-response
9021 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9023 yes | yes | yes | no
9024 Arguments : none
9025
9026 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9027 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9028 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9029 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9030 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9031 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9032 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9033 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9034 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9035
9036 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9037 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9038
9039 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9040 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9041 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9042 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9043
9044 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9045 "hard-stop-after"
9046
9047
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009048option log-health-checks
9049no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009050 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009051 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9052 yes | no | yes | yes
9053 Arguments : none
9054
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009055 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9056 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9057 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009058
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009059 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9060 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9061 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9062 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9063 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9064
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009065 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009066 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009067
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009068 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9069 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9070 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009071
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009072
9073option log-separate-errors
9074no option log-separate-errors
9075 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9077 yes | yes | yes | no
9078 Arguments : none
9079
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009080 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009081 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9082 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9083 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9084 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9085 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9086 provides very important information.
9087
9088 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9089 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9090 error logs.
9091
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009092 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009093 logging.
9094
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009095
9096option logasap
9097no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009098 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9100 yes | yes | yes | no
9101 Arguments : none
9102
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009103 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9104 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9105 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9106 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9107
9108 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9109 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9110 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9111 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9112 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009113 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009114 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9115 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9116 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9117 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009118 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009119
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009120 Examples :
9121 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9122 mode http
9123 option httplog
9124 option logasap
9125 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9126
9127 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9128 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9129 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9130 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9131
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009132 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009133 logging.
9134
9135
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009136option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009137 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009138 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9139 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009140 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009141 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9142 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009143 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9144 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009145
9146 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9147 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009148 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009149 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009150 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9151 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9152 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009153
Daniel Blackd3e7dc42021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009154 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9155 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9156 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009157
9158 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009159 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009160 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9161 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9162 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9163 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9164 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9165 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9166 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9167
9168 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9169 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009170
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009171 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009172
9173 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9174 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9175 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9176 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009177 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009178 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009179
9180 See also: "option httpchk"
9181
9182
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009183option nolinger
9184no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009185 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009186 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9187 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009188 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009189
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009190 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009191 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9192 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9193 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9194 connections.
9195
9196 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9197 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009198 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9199 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9200 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9201 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9202 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9203 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9204 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9205 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9206 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9207 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9208 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9209 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9210 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009211
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009212 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9213 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9214 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9215 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9216 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009217
9218 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9219 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009220 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009221 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009222 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009223
9224 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9225 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9226
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009227 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9228 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009229
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009230option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9231 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9232 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9233 yes | yes | yes | yes
9234 Arguments :
9235 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9236 matching <network>
9237 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9238 header name.
9239
9240 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9241 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9242 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9243 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9244 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9245 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9246 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9247 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9248 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9249 possible that the client has already brought one.
9250
9251 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9252 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9253 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9254 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9255 header and requires different one.
9256
9257 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9258 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9259 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009260 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9261 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9262 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9263 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9264 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009265
9266 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9267 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9268 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9269 both are defined.
9270
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009271 Examples :
9272 # Original Destination address
9273 frontend www
9274 mode http
9275 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9276
9277 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9278 backend www
9279 mode http
9280 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9281
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009282 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009283
9284
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009285option persist
9286no option persist
9287 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9288 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9289 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009290 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009291
9292 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9293 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9294 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9295 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9296 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9297 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9298 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9299 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9300 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9301 redirected to another valid server.
9302
9303 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9304 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9305
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009306 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009307
9308
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009309option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
9310 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9311 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9312 yes | no | yes | yes
9313 Arguments :
9314 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9315 PostgreSQL server.
9316
9317 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9318 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9319 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9320 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9321
9322 See also: "option httpchk"
9323
9324
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009325option prefer-last-server
9326no option prefer-last-server
9327 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9328 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9329 yes | no | yes | yes
9330 Arguments : none
9331
9332 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009333 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009334 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9335 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009336 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009337 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009338 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009339 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9340 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009341 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009342 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009343 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9344 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9345 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009346 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9347 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9348 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009349
9350 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9351 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9352
9353 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9354
9355
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009356option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009357option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009358no option redispatch
9359 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9360 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9361 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009362 Arguments :
9363 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9364 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9365 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009366 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009367 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009368 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009369 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9370 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9371 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009373
9374 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9375 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9376 be able to access the service anymore.
9377
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009378 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9379 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009380
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009381 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9382 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9383 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9384 following order:
9385
9386 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9387
9388 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9389 list, or
9390
9391 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9392
9393 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9394 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9395
9396 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9397 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9398 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9399 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9400
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009401 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009402 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9403 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009404
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009405 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9406 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9407
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009408 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009409
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009410
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009411option redis-check
9412 Use redis health checks for server testing
9413 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9414 yes | no | yes | yes
9415 Arguments : none
9416
9417 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9418 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9419 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9420 find the "+PONG" response message.
9421
9422 Example :
9423 option redis-check
9424
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009425 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009426
9427
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009428option smtpchk
9429option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9430 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9431 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9432 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009433 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009434 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009435 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009436 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9437
9438 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9439 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9440 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9441
9442 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9443 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9444 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9445 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9446 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9447 dead server.
9448
9449 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9450 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009451 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009452 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9453
9454 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9455 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9456 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9457 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009458 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009459
9460 Example :
9461 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9462
9463 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9464
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009465
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009466option socket-stats
9467no option socket-stats
9468
9469 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9470 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9471 yes | yes | yes | no
9472
9473 Arguments : none
9474
9475
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009476option splice-auto
9477no option splice-auto
9478 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9479 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9480 yes | yes | yes | yes
9481 Arguments : none
9482
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009483 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009484 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009485 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009486 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009487 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009488 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9489 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9490 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9491 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9492
9493 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9494 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9495 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9496 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9497 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9498 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9499 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9500 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9501 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9502 keyword.
9503
9504 Example :
9505 option splice-auto
9506
9507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9509
9510 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9511 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9512
9513
9514option splice-request
9515no option splice-request
9516 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9518 yes | yes | yes | yes
9519 Arguments : none
9520
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009521 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009522 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009523 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9524 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9525 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9526 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9527
9528 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9529
9530 Example :
9531 option splice-request
9532
9533 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9534 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9535
9536 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9537 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9538
9539
9540option splice-response
9541no option splice-response
9542 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9544 yes | yes | yes | yes
9545 Arguments : none
9546
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009547 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009548 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009549 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9550 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9551 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9552 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9553
9554 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9555
9556 Example :
9557 option splice-response
9558
9559 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9560 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9561
9562 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9563 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9564
9565
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009566option spop-check
9567 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9568 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9569 no | no | no | yes
9570 Arguments : none
9571
9572 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9573 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9574 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9575 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9576
9577 Example :
9578 option spop-check
9579
9580 See also : "option httpchk"
9581
9582
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009583option srvtcpka
9584no option srvtcpka
9585 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9586 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9587 yes | no | yes | yes
9588 Arguments : none
9589
9590 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9591 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009592 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009593 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9594
9595 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9596 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9597 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9598 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9599
9600 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9601 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9602 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9603 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9604 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9605
9606 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9607
9608 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9609 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9610 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9611
9612 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9613 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9614
9615 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9616
9617
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009618option ssl-hello-chk
9619 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9620 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9621 yes | no | yes | yes
9622 Arguments : none
9623
9624 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9625 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9626 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9627 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9628 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9629 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9630 hello message.
9631
9632 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9633 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9634 messages, which is appreciable.
9635
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009636 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009637 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9638 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009639
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009640 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9641
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009642
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009643option tcp-check
9644 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9645 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9646 yes | no | yes | yes
9647
9648 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9649 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9650
9651 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9652 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9653 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9654
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009655 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009656 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9657 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9658 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9659 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9660 only.
9661
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009662 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009663 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009664 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9665 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9666 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9667
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009668 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009669 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9670 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009671 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009672 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9673 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9674 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9675 the respective protocols.
9676 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009677 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009678
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009679 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009680
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009681 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9682 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9683 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9684 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009685
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009686 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9687 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9688 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009689
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009690
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009691 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009692 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009693 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009694 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009695
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009696 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009697 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009698 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009699
9700 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9701 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009702 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009703 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009704 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009705 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009706 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009707 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009708 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9709 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009710 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009711 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9712 tcp-check expect string +OK
9713
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009714 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009715 (send many headers before analyzing)
9716 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009717 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009718 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9719 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9720 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9721 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009722 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009723
9724
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009725 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009726
9727
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009728option tcp-smart-accept
9729no option tcp-smart-accept
9730 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9731 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9732 yes | yes | yes | no
9733 Arguments : none
9734
9735 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9736 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9737 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9738 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9739 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9740 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9741
9742 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9743 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9744 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9745 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9746
9747 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9748 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9749 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009750 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009751
9752 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9753 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9754 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9755
9756 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9757 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9758 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9759
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009760 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9761
9762
9763option tcp-smart-connect
9764no option tcp-smart-connect
9765 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9766 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9767 yes | no | yes | yes
9768 Arguments : none
9769
9770 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9771 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9772 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9773 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9774 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9775
9776 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9777 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9778 complex.
9779
9780 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9781 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9782 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9783
9784 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9785 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9786
9787 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9788
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009789
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009790option tcpka
9791 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9792 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9793 yes | yes | yes | yes
9794 Arguments : none
9795
9796 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9797 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009798 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009799 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9800
9801 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9802 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9803 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9804 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9805
9806 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9807 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9808 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9809 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9810 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9811
9812 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9813
9814 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9815 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9816 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9817 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9818 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9819 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9820 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9821 backends.
9822
9823 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9824
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009825
9826option tcplog
9827 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009829 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009830 Arguments : none
9831
9832 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9833 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9834 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9835 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9836 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9837 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9838 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9839 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9840
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009841 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9842
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009843 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009844
9845
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009846option transparent
9847no option transparent
9848 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9849 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009850 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009851 Arguments : none
9852
9853 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9854 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9855 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9856 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9857 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9858 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9859 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9860 appropriate server.
9861
9862 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9863 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9864
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009865 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009866 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009867
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009868
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009869external-check command <command>
9870 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9871 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9872 yes | no | yes | yes
9873
9874 Arguments :
9875 <command> is the external command to run
9876
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009877 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9878
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009879 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009880
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009881 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9882 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9883 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9884 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9885 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9886 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009887
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009888 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9889
9890 Environment variables :
9891 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9892 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9893
9894 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9895
9896 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9897
9898 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9899 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9900 for a UNIX socket).
9901
9902 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9903
9904 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9905
9906 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9907
9908 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9909
9910 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9911
9912 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9913 socket).
9914
9915 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9916 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9917
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009918 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9919
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009920 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9921 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9922 failed.
9923
9924 Example :
9925 external-check command /bin/true
9926
9927 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9928
9929
9930external-check path <path>
9931 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9932 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9933 yes | no | yes | yes
9934
9935 Arguments :
9936 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9937
9938 The default path is "".
9939
9940 Example :
9941 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9942
9943 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9944 "external-check command"
9945
9946
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009947persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009948persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009949 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9950 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9951 yes | no | yes | yes
9952 Arguments :
9953 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009954 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
9955 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009956
9957 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
9958 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009959 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009960 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
9961 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
9962 forwarded to this server.
9963
9964 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
9965 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
9966 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009967 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009968 a single "listen" section.
9969
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009970 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
9971 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
9972 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
9973
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009974 Example :
9975 listen tse-farm
9976 bind :3389
9977 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
9978 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
9979 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
9980 # apply RDP cookie persistence
9981 persist rdp-cookie
9982 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02009983 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009984 balance rdp-cookie
9985 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
9986 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
9987
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09009988 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
9989 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009990
9991
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01009992rate-limit sessions <rate>
9993 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
9994 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9995 yes | yes | yes | no
9996 Arguments :
9997 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
9998 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
9999
10000 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10001 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10002 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010003 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010004 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10005 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10006
10007 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10008 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10009 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10010 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10011
10012 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10013 listen smtp
10014 mode tcp
10015 bind :25
10016 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010017 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010018
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010019 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10020 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10021 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010022
10023 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10024
10025
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010026redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10027redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10028redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010029 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10031 no | yes | yes | yes
10032
10033 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010034 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010035
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010036 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010037 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010038 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10039 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10040 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010041
10042 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10043 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10044 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10045 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10046 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010047 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10048 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10049 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10050 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010051
10052 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10053 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10054 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10055 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10056 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10057 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010058 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010059 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010060 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10061 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10062 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010063
10064 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010065 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10066 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10067 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010068 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010069 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10070 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10071 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10072 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010073
10074 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010075 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010076
10077 - "drop-query"
10078 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10079 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10080 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10081 with a location-type redirect.
10082
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010083 - "append-slash"
10084 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10085 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10086 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10087 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10088
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010089 - "ignore-empty"
10090 This keyword only has effect when a location is produced using a log
10091 format expression (i.e. when used in http-request or http-response).
10092 It indicates that if the result of the expression is empty, the rule
10093 should silently be skipped. The main use is to allow mass-redirects
10094 of known paths using a simple map.
10095
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010096 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10097 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10098 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10099 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10100 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10101 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10102 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10103
10104 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10105 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10106 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10107 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10108 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10109 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10110 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010111
10112 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10113 acl clear dst_port 80
10114 acl secure dst_port 8080
10115 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010116 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010117 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010118 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10119
10120 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010121 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10122 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10123 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010124 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010125
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010126 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10127 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10128 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10129
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010130 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010131 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010132
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010133 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010134 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10135 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10136 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010137
Willy Tarreaubc1223b2021-09-02 16:54:33 +020010138 Example: permanently redirect only old URLs to new ones
10139 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10140 %[path,map_str(old-blog-articles.map)] ignore-empty
10141
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010142 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010143
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010144
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010145retries <value>
10146 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10147 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10148 yes | no | yes | yes
10149 Arguments :
10150 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10151 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10152 default value is 3.
10153
10154 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10155 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10156 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10157
10158 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010159 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10160 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010161
10162 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10163 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10164
10165 See also : "option redispatch"
10166
10167
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010168retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010169 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10170 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10171 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010172 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10173 yes | no | yes | yes
10174 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010175 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10176 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10177 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10178 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10179 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010180
10181 none never retry
10182
10183 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10184 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10185
10186 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10187 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10188 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10189 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10190 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10191 processing the request.
10192
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010193 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10194 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10195 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10196 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10197 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10198 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10199 overflow attack for example).
10200
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010201 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10202 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10203 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10204 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10205 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10206 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10207 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10208 amplify denial of service attacks.
10209
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010210 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10211 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10212 considered to be safe to retry.
10213
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010214 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10215 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10216 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10217 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10218 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010219
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010220 all-retryable-errors
10221 retry request for any error that are considered
10222 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10223 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10224 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10225
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010226 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10227 not cumulative.
10228
10229 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10230 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10231 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10232 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10233
10234 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10235 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10236 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10237 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10238 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10239 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10240 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10241 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10242 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10243 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10244 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10245 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10246
10247 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10248 should not use this directive.
10249
10250 The default is "conn-failure".
10251
Lukas Tribusde160082021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010252 Example:
10253 retry-on 503 504
10254
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010255 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10256
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010257server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010258 Declare a server in a backend
10259 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10260 no | no | yes | yes
10261 Arguments :
10262 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010263 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010264 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010265
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010266 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10267 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10268 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10269 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010270 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10271 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010272 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010273 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10274 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010275 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10276 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10277 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10278 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10279 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10280 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10281 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010282 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010283 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10284 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10285 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10286 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10287 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10288 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010289 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10290 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010291 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10292 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010293
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010294 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010295 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10296 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10297 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10298 adding this value to the client's port.
10299
10300 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10301 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010302 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010303
10304 Examples :
10305 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10306 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010307 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010308 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10309 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10310 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010311
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010312 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10313 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10314 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10315 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10316 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10317
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010318 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10319 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010320
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010321server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010322 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010323 this backend.
10324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10325 no | no | yes | yes
10326
10327 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10328 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10329 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10330 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10331 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010332
10333 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10334 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10335
10336 global
10337 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10338
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010339 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010340 load-server-state-from-file
10341
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010342 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010343 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010344
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010345server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10346 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10347 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10349 no | no | yes | yes
10350
10351 Arguments:
10352 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10353
10354 <num | range>
10355 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10356 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10357 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10358 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10359
10360 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10361
10362 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10363
10364 <params*>
10365 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10366 keyword.
10367
10368 Examples:
10369 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10370 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10371 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10372
10373 # or
10374 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10375
10376 # would be equivalent to:
10377 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10378 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10379 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10380
10381
10382
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010383source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010384source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010385source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010386 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10388 yes | no | yes | yes
10389 Arguments :
10390 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10391 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010392
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010393 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010394 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10395 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10396 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10397 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10398 supported prefixes are :
10399 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10400 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10401 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010402 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010403 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10404 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010405
10406 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10407 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010408 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10409 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10410 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010411
10412 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10413 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10414 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10415 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10416 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10417 <addr>.
10418
10419 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10420 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10421 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10422 port.
10423
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010424 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10425 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10426 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10427 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010428 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010429 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10430 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10431 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10432 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10433 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10434 HTTP header.
10435
10436 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10437 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010438 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010439 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10440 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10441 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10442 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10443 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10444 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10445 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10446
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010447 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10448 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10449 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10450 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10451 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10452 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10453
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010454 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10455 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10456 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10457 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10458
10459 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10460 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10461 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10462 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10463 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10464 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10465
10466 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10467 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10468 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10469 there are two methods :
10470
10471 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10472 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10473 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10474 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10475 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10476 of the client ranges may be used.
10477
10478 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10479 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10480 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10481 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10482 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10483 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10484 same session.
10485
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010486 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10487 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10488 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010489 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010490
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010491 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10492
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010493 Examples :
10494 backend private
10495 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10496 source 192.168.1.200
10497
10498 backend transparent_ssl1
10499 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10500 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10501
10502 backend transparent_ssl2
10503 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10504 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10505 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10506
10507 backend transparent_ssl3
10508 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10509 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10510 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10511
10512 backend transparent_smtp
10513 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10514 # with Tproxy version 4.
10515 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10516
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010517 backend transparent_http
10518 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10519 # proxy.
10520 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010522 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010523 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10524
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010525
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010526srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10527 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10528 the connection on the server side.
10529 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10530 yes | no | yes | yes
10531 Arguments :
10532 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10533
10534 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10535 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010536 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10537 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010538
10539 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10540
10541
10542srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10543 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10544 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10545 server side.
10546 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10547 yes | no | yes | yes
10548 Arguments :
10549 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10550 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10551 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10552 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10553
10554 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10555 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010556 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10557 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010558
10559 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10560
10561
10562srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10563 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10564 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10565 yes | no | yes | yes
10566 Arguments :
10567 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10568 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10569 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10570 document.
10571
10572 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10573 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010574 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10575 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010576
10577 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10578
10579
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010580stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10581 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010583 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010584
10585 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10586 matched.
10587
10588 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10589 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10590
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010591 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10592 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10593 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10594 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010595
10596 Example :
10597 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10598 backend stats_localhost
10599 stats enable
10600 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10601
10602 Example :
10603 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10604 backend stats_auth
10605 stats enable
10606 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10607 stats admin if TRUE
10608
10609 Example :
10610 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10611 userlist stats-auth
10612 group admin users admin
10613 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10614 group readonly users haproxy
10615 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10616
10617 backend stats_auth
10618 stats enable
10619 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10620 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10621 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10622 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10623
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020010624 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", section 3.4
10625 about userlists and section 7 about ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010626
10627
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010628stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10629 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10630 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010631 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010632 Arguments :
10633 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10634
10635 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10636
10637 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10638 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10639 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10640 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10641 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10642 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10643
10644 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10645 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10646 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010647 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010648
10649 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10650 report using "stats scope".
10651
10652 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10653 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10654 unobvious parameters.
10655
10656 Example :
10657 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10658 backend public_www
10659 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10660 stats enable
10661 stats hide-version
10662 stats scope .
10663 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010664 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010665 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10666 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10667
10668 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10669 backend private_monitoring
10670 stats enable
10671 stats uri /admin?stats
10672 stats refresh 5s
10673
10674 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10675
10676
10677stats enable
10678 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10679 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010680 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010681 Arguments : none
10682
10683 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10684 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10685 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10686 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10687 - stats auth : no authentication
10688 - stats scope : no restriction
10689
10690 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10691 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10692 unobvious parameters.
10693
10694 Example :
10695 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10696 backend public_www
10697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10698 stats enable
10699 stats hide-version
10700 stats scope .
10701 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010702 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010703 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10704 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10705
10706 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10707 backend private_monitoring
10708 stats enable
10709 stats uri /admin?stats
10710 stats refresh 5s
10711
10712 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10713
10714
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010715stats hide-version
10716 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010718 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010719 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010720
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010721 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10722 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10723 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10724 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10725 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10726 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010727
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10730 unobvious parameters.
10731
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010732 Example :
10733 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10734 backend public_www
10735 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010736 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010737 stats hide-version
10738 stats scope .
10739 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010741 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10742 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010743
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10745 backend private_monitoring
10746 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010747 stats uri /admin?stats
10748 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010749
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010750 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010751
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010752
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010753stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10754 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10755 Access control for statistics
10756
10757 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10758 no | no | yes | yes
10759
10760 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10761 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10762 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10763 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10764 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10765 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10766
10767 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10768 instance.
10769
10770 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10771 about ACL usage.
10772
10773
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010774stats realm <realm>
10775 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010777 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010778 Arguments :
10779 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10780 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10781 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10782
10783 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10784 using a backslash ('\').
10785
10786 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10787 only related to authentication.
10788
10789 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10790 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10791 unobvious parameters.
10792
10793 Example :
10794 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10795 backend public_www
10796 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10797 stats enable
10798 stats hide-version
10799 stats scope .
10800 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010801 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010802 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10803 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10804
10805 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10806 backend private_monitoring
10807 stats enable
10808 stats uri /admin?stats
10809 stats refresh 5s
10810
10811 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10812
10813
10814stats refresh <delay>
10815 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10816 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010817 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010818 Arguments :
10819 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10820 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10821 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10822 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10823 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10824 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10825
10826 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10827 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10828 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010829 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010830
10831 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10832 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10833 unobvious parameters.
10834
10835 Example :
10836 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10837 backend public_www
10838 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10839 stats enable
10840 stats hide-version
10841 stats scope .
10842 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010843 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010844 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10845 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10846
10847 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10848 backend private_monitoring
10849 stats enable
10850 stats uri /admin?stats
10851 stats refresh 5s
10852
10853 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10854
10855
10856stats scope { <name> | "." }
10857 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10858 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010859 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010860 Arguments :
10861 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10862 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10863 section in which the statement appears.
10864
10865 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10866 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10867 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10868 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10869 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10870 exists.
10871
10872 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10873 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10874 unobvious parameters.
10875
10876 Example :
10877 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10878 backend public_www
10879 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10880 stats enable
10881 stats hide-version
10882 stats scope .
10883 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010884 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010885 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10886 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10887
10888 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10889 backend private_monitoring
10890 stats enable
10891 stats uri /admin?stats
10892 stats refresh 5s
10893
10894 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10895
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010896
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010897stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010898 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010900 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010901
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010902 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010903 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10904
10905 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10906 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10907
10908 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10909 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010910 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010911
10912 Example :
10913 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10914 backend private_monitoring
10915 stats enable
10916 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10917 stats uri /admin?stats
10918 stats refresh 5s
10919
10920 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10921 global section.
10922
10923
10924stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010925 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10926 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10927 yes | yes | yes | yes
10928 Arguments : none
10929
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010930 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010931 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10932 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10933 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10934 - IP (socket, server)
10935 - cookie (backend, server)
10936
10937 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10938 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010939 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010940
10941 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10942
10943
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010944stats show-modules
10945 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10946 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10947 yes | yes | yes | yes
10948 Arguments : none
10949
10950 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10951 values as a tooltip.
10952
10953 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10954 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10955 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10956
10957 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10958
10959
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010960stats show-node [ <name> ]
10961 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
10962 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010963 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010964 Arguments:
10965 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
10966 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
10967
10968 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10969 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010970 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010971
10972 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10973 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10974 unobvious parameters.
10975
10976 Example:
10977 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10978 backend private_monitoring
10979 stats enable
10980 stats show-node Europe-1
10981 stats uri /admin?stats
10982 stats refresh 5s
10983
10984 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
10985 section.
10986
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010987
10988stats uri <prefix>
10989 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
10990 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010991 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010992 Arguments :
10993 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
10994 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
10995 query string.
10996
10997 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
10998 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
10999 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11000 possible to reach it in the application.
11001
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011002 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011003 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011004 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11005 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11006 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11007 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11008
11009 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11010 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11011 an address or a port to statistics only.
11012
11013 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11014 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11015 unobvious parameters.
11016
11017 Example :
11018 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11019 backend public_www
11020 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11021 stats enable
11022 stats hide-version
11023 stats scope .
11024 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011025 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011026 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11027 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11028
11029 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11030 backend private_monitoring
11031 stats enable
11032 stats uri /admin?stats
11033 stats refresh 5s
11034
11035 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11036
11037
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011038stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11039 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011040 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011041 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011042
11043 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011044 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011045 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011046 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011047 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11048
11049 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11050 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11051 the "stick-table" statement.
11052
11053 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11054 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11055 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11056 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11057 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11058
11059 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11060 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11061 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11062 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11063 transformation rules.
11064
11065 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11066 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11067 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11068 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11069 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11070 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11071 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11072
11073 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11074 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11075 ACL based conditions.
11076
11077 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11078 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11079 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11080 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11081
11082 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11083 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11084 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11085 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11086
11087 Example :
11088 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11089 # last 30 minutes
11090 backend pop
11091 mode tcp
11092 balance roundrobin
11093 stick store-request src
11094 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11095 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11096 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11097
11098 backend smtp
11099 mode tcp
11100 balance roundrobin
11101 stick match src table pop
11102 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11103 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11104
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011105 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and samples
11106 fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011107
11108
11109stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11110 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11111 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11112 no | no | yes | yes
11113
11114 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11115 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11116 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11117 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11118
11119 Examples :
11120 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011121 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011122
11123 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11124 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11125 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11126
11127
11128 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11129 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11130 backend http
11131 mode http
11132 balance roundrobin
11133 stick on src table https
11134 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11135 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11136 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11137
11138 backend https
11139 mode tcp
11140 balance roundrobin
11141 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11142 stick on src
11143 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11144 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11145
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011146 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011147
11148
11149stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11150 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11152 no | no | yes | yes
11153
11154 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011155 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011156 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011157 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011158 server is selected.
11159
11160 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11161 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11162 the "stick-table" statement.
11163
11164 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11165 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11166 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11167 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11168 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11169 address.
11170
11171 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11172 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11173 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11174 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11175 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11176 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11177 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11178 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11179 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11180 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11181
11182 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11183 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11184 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11185 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11186 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11187 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11188 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11189
11190 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11191 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11192 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11193 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11194
11195 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11196 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11197 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11198 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11199 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11200 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011201 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11202 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11203 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11204 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11205 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11206 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011207
11208 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11209 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11210 the request.
11211
11212 Example :
11213 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11214 # last 30 minutes
11215 backend pop
11216 mode tcp
11217 balance roundrobin
11218 stick store-request src
11219 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11220 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11221 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11222
11223 backend smtp
11224 mode tcp
11225 balance roundrobin
11226 stick match src table pop
11227 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11228 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11229
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020011230 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011231
11232
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011233stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011234 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011235 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011236 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011237 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011238 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011239
11240 Arguments :
11241 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11242 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11243 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11244 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11245
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011246 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11247 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11248 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11249 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11250
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011251 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11252 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11253 instance.
11254
11255 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11256 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11257 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11258 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11259 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11260 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011261 to 32 characters.
11262
11263 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11264 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11265 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011266 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011267 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11268 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011269
11270 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011271 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11272 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011273 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11274 increase.
11275
11276 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011277 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11278 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11279 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011280
11281 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011282 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011283 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11284 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011285 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011286 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11287 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11288 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11289 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11290 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11291 parameter (see below).
11292
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011293 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11294 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11295 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11296 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11297 soft restart.
11298
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011299 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
11300 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
11301 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11302 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011303 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011304 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011305 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11306 if not expiration delay is specified.
11307
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011308 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11309 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11310 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11311 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11312 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11313 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11314 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11315 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11316 token.
11317
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011318 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11319 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11320 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11321 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011322 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11323 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11324 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11325 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11326 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11327 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11328 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11329 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11330 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11331 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11332 types and their arguments.
11333
11334 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11335 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11336 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11337 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11338
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011339 - gpc(<nb>) : General Purpose Counters Array of <nb> elements. This is an
11340 array of positive 32-bit integers which may be used to count anything.
11341 Most of the time they will be used as a incremental counters on some
11342 entries, for instance to note that a limit is reached and trigger some
11343 actions. This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements:
11344 gpc0 to gpc99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11345 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11346 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11347 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11348 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011349 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types 'gpc0'
11350 and 'gpc1' on the same table. Using the 'gpc' array data_type, all 'gpc0'
11351 and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions will apply to the two first
11352 elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011353
11354 - gpc_rate(<nb>,<period>) : Array of increment rates of General Purpose
11355 Counters over a period. Those elements are positive 32-bit integers which
11356 may be used for anything. Just like <gpc>, the count events, but instead
11357 of keeping a cumulative number, they maintain the rate at which the
11358 counter is incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the
11359 frequency of occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific
11360 URL). This array is limited to a maximum of 100 elements: gpc0 to gpc99,
11361 to ensure that the build of a peer update message can fit into the
11362 buffer. Users should take in consideration that a large amount of
11363 counters will increase the data size and the traffic load using peers
11364 protocol since all data/counters are pushed each time any of them is
11365 updated.
Emeric Brun726783d2021-06-30 19:06:43 +020011366 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_types
11367 'gpc0_rate' and 'gpc1_rate' on the same table. Using the 'gpc_rate'
11368 array data_type, all 'gpc0' and 'gpc1' related fetches and actions
11369 will apply to the two first elements of this array.
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020011370
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011371 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11372 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11373 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011374 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011375
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011376 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11377 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11378 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011379 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011380 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011381 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011382
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011383 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11384 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11385 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11386 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11387
11388 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11389 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11390 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11391 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11392 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11393 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11394
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011395 - gpt(<nb>) : General Purpose Tags Array of <nb> elements. This is an array
11396 of positive 32-bit integers which may be used for anything.
11397 Most of the time they will be used to put a special tags on some entries,
11398 for instance to note that a specific behavior was detected and must be
11399 known for future matches. This array is limited to a maximum of 100
11400 elements: gpt0 to gpt99, to ensure that the build of a peer update
11401 message can fit into the buffer. Users should take in consideration
11402 that a large amount of counters will increase the data size and the
11403 traffic load using peers protocol since all data/counters are pushed
11404 each time any of them is updated.
Emeric Brunf7ab0bf2021-06-30 18:58:22 +020011405 This data_type will exclude the usage of the legacy data_type 'gpt0'
11406 on the same table. Using the 'gpt' array data_type, all 'gpt0' related
11407 fetches and actions will apply to the first element of this array.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020011408
Emeric Brun1a6b7252021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011409 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11410 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11411 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11412 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11413
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011414 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11415 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11416 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11417 they were received.
11418
11419 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11420 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11421 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11422 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11423 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11424
11425 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11426 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11427 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11428 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11429 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11430
11431 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11432 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11433 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11434
11435 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11436 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11437 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11438 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11439 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11440
11441 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11442 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11443 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11444 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11445 the client side.
11446
11447 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11448 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11449 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11450 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11451 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11452 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11453 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11454
11455 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11456 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11457 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11458 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11459 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11460 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011461 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011462
11463 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11464 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11465 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11466 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11467 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11468 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11469
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011470 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11471 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11472 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11473 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11474 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11475
11476 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11477 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11478 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11479 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11480 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11481 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11482
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011483 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011484 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011485 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11486 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11487
11488 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11489 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11490 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11491 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11492 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11493 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11494 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11495 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11496 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11497 recommended for better fairness.
11498
11499 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011500 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011501 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11502 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11503
11504 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11505 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11506 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11507 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11508 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11509 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11510 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11511 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11512 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11513 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011514
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011515 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11516 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011517 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11518 reference it.
11519
11520 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11521 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011522 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11523 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11524 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011525
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011526 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11527 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11528 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11529 something that can be ignored.
11530
11531 Example:
11532 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11533 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11534 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11535 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11536
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011537 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011538 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011539
11540
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011541stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011542 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011543 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11544 no | no | yes | yes
11545
11546 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011547 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011548 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011549 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011550 server is selected.
11551
11552 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11553 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11554 the "stick-table" statement.
11555
11556 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11557 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11558 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11559 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11560
11561 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11562 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11563 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11564 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11565 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11566 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011567 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011568 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11569 rules.
11570
11571 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11572 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11573 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11574 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11575 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11576 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11577 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11578
11579 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11580 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11581 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11582 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11583
11584 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11585 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11586 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11587 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11588 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11589 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011590 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11591 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11592 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11593 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11594 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11595 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11596 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11597 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11598 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011599
11600 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11601
11602 Example :
11603 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11604 backend https
11605 mode tcp
11606 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011607 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011608 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011609
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011610 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
11611 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
11612
11613 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11614 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11615 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11616
11617 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11618 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011619
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011620 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11621 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11622 # at offset 44.
11623
11624 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
11625 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
11626
11627 # Learn on response if server hello.
11628 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011629
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011630 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11631 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11632
11633 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11634 extraction.
11635
11636
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011637tcp-check comment <string>
11638 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11639 it fails.
11640 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11641 yes | no | yes | yes
11642
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011643 Arguments :
11644 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11645 rule fails.
11646
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011647 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11648 user-friendly error reporting.
11649
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011650 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11651 "tcp-check expect".
11652
11653
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011654tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11655 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011656 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011657 Opens a new connection
11658 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011659 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011660
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011661 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011662 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11663
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011664 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011665 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011666
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011667 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011668 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11669 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011670 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011671
11672 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011673
11674 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11675
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011676 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11677
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011678 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11679
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011680 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11681
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011682 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11683 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11684 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11685 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11686
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011687 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11688 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11689 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11690 haproxy -vv.
11691
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011692 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011693
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011694 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11695 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11696 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11697
11698 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11699 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11700 of the sequence.
11701
11702 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11703 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11704 do.
11705
11706 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11707 unset-var or comment rules.
11708
11709 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011710 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11711 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11712 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11713 option tcp-check
11714 tcp-check connect
11715 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11716 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11717 tcp-check send \r\n
11718 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11719 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11720 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11721 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11722 tcp-check send \r\n
11723 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11724 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11725
11726 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11727 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011728 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011729 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11730 tcp-check connect port 143
11731 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11732 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11733
11734 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11735
11736
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011737tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011738 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011739 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011740 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011741 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011742 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011743 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011744
11745 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011746 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11747
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011748 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11749 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11750 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11751 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11752 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11753 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11754 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11755 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11756 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11757 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11758
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011759 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011760 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11761 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011762 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11763 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11764 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11765
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011766 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11767 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11768 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011769 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11770 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011771 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11772 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011773 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11774 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011775 By default "L7OK" is used.
11776
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011777 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11778 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011779 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11780 supported :
11781 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11782 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011783 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11784 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11785 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11786 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11787 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011788
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011789 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011790 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011791 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11792 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11793 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11794 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011795 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11796
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011797 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11798 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11799 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11800 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11801
11802 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11803 informational message reported in logs if an error
11804 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11805 log-format string.
11806
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011807 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11808 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11809 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11810 followed by some converters.
11811
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011812 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11813 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11814 with the usual backslash ('\').
11815 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011816 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011817 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11818 used upper or lower case.
11819
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011820 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11821
11822 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11823 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11824 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11825 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11826 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11827 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11828 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11829 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11830
11831 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11832 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11833 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11834 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11835 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11836 expression.
11837
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011838 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11839 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11840 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11841 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11842 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11843 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11844
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011845 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11846 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11847 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11848 this exact hexadecimal string.
11849 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11850
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011851 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11852 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11853 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11854 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11855 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11856 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11857 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11858 size.
11859
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011860 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11861 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11862 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11863 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11864 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11865 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11866 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11867 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11868 in a binary string before matching the response's
11869 buffer.
11870
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011871 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011872 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011873 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11874 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11875 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11876 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11877 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11878 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11879 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11880 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11881 the null character.
11882
11883 Examples :
11884 # perform a POP check
11885 option tcp-check
11886 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11887
11888 # perform an IMAP check
11889 option tcp-check
11890 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11891
11892 # look for the redis master server
11893 option tcp-check
11894 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011895 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011896 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11897 tcp-check expect string role:master
11898 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11899 tcp-check expect string +OK
11900
11901
11902 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011903 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011904
11905
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011906tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11907tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11908 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11909 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011910 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011911 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011912
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011913 Arguments :
11914 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11915
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011916 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11917 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011918
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011919 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11920 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011921
11922 Examples :
11923 # look for the redis master server
11924 option tcp-check
11925 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11926 tcp-check expect string role:master
11927
11928 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011929 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011930
11931
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011932tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11933tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11934 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11935 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011937 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011938
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011939 Arguments :
11940 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011941
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011942 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11943 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011944
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011945 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11946 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11947 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011948
11949 Examples :
11950 # redis check in binary
11951 option tcp-check
11952 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11953 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11954
11955
11956 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011957 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011958
11959
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010011960tcp-check set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
11961tcp-check set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011962 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011964 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011965
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011966 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011967 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11968 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11969 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11970 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11971 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11972 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11973 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11974 and '-'.
11975
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010011976 <cond> A set of conditions that must all be true for the variable to
11977 actually be set (such as "ifnotempty", "ifgt" ...). See the
Ilya Shipitsin5e87bcf2021-12-25 11:45:52 +050011978 set-var converter's description for a full list of possible
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010011979 conditions.
11980
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011981 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11982
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011983 <fmt> This is the value expressed using log-format rules (see Custom
11984 Log Format in section 8.2.4).
11985
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011986 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011987 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020011988 tcp-check set-var-fmt(check.name) "%H"
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011989
11990
11991tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011992 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011993 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011994 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011995
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011996 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011997 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11998 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11999 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12000 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12001 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12002 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12003 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12004 and '-'.
12005
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012006 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012007 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12008
12009
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012010tcp-request connection <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012011 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012012 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012013 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012014 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012015 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12016 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012017
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012018 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012019
12020 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12021 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012022 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12023 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12024 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12025 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12026 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12027 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012028
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012029 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12030 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12031 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012032 rules which may be inserted. Any rule may optionally be followed by an
12033 ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition
12034 is true.
12035
12036 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12037 supported:
12038 - accept
12039 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12040 - expect-proxy layer4
12041 - reject
12042 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12043 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12044 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12045 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12046 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12047 - set-dst <expr>
12048 - set-dst-port <expr>
12049 - set-mark <mark>
12050 - set-src <expr>
12051 - set-src-port <expr>
12052 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012053 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12054 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012055 - silent-drop
12056 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12057 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12058 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012059 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012060
12061 The supported actions are described below.
12062
12063 There is no limit to the number of "tcp-request connection" statements per
12064 instance.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012065
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012066 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12067 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12068 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12069 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12070 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12071 a defaults section defining such rules.
12072
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012073 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12074 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12075 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012076
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012077 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12078 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12079 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012080
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012081 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12082 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
12083 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012084
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012085 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12086 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12087 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012088
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012089 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12090 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12091 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012092
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012093 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012094
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012095 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012096
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012097 See section 7 about ACL usage.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012098
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012099 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012100
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012101tcp-request connection accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012102
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012103 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12104 rules are evaluated.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012105
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012106tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip layer4
12107 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012108
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012109 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client IP
12110 insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket. This is
12111 equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the "bind" line,
12112 except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only
12113 for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple
12114 layers of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12115 hosts.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012116
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012117tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012118
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012119 This configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12120 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to having
12121 the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule
12122 allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges
12123 using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are
12124 passed through by traffic coming from public hosts.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012125
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012126tcp-request connection reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012127
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012128 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request connection"
12129 rules are evaluated. Rejected connections do not even become a session, which
12130 is why they are accounted separately for in the stats, as "denied
12131 connections". They are not considered for the session rate-limit and are not
12132 logged either. The reason is that these rules should only be used to filter
12133 extremely high connection rates such as the ones encountered during a massive
12134 DDoS attack. Under these extreme conditions, the simple action of logging
12135 each event would make the system collapse and would considerably lower the
12136 filtering capacity. If logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request
12137 content" rules should be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will
12138 not log either.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012139
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012140tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12141tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12142tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012143
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012144 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12145 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12146 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12147 description.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012148
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012149tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12150 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12151tcp-request connection sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12152 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012153
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012154 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12155 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12156 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012157
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012158tcp-request connection set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12159tcp-request connection set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012160
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012161 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12162 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12163 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012164
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012165tcp-request connection set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012166
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012167 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12168 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12169 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012170
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012171tcp-request connection set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12172tcp-request connection set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012173
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012174 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12175 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12176 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012177
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012178tcp-request connection set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012179
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012180 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12181 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12182 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012183
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012184tcp-request connection set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12185tcp-request connection set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012186
12187 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12188 inline. "tcp-request connection" can set variables in the "proc" and "sess"
12189 scopes. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12190 for a complete description.
12191
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012192tcp-request connection silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012193
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012194 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12195 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12196 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12197 complete description.
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012198
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012199tcp-request connection track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12200tcp-request connection track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12201tcp-request connection track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012202
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012203 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12204 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12205 track-sc2" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012206
Jaroslaw Rzeszótkoc8637032021-11-02 16:56:05 +010012207tcp-request connection unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12208
12209 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12210 details about variables.
12211
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012212
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012213tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12214 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012215 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012216 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012217 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012218 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12219 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012220
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012221 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012222
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012223 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012224 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12225 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012226 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12227 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012229 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12230 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12231 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12232 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012233 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012234 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012235 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12236 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12237 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12238 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012239 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012240 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012241
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012242 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12243 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12244 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12245 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012246
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012247 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12248 supported:
12249 - accept
12250 - capture <sample> len <length>
12251 - do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12252 - reject
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012253 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012254 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012255 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012256 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012257 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012258 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012259 - set-dst <expr>
12260 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012261 - set-log-level <level>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012262 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012263 - set-nice <nice>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012264 - set-priority-class <expr>
12265 - set-priority-offset <expr>
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012266 - set-src <expr>
12267 - set-src-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012268 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012269 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12270 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012271 - silent-drop
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012272 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012273 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12274 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12275 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012276 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012277 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012278
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012279 The supported actions are described below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012280
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012281 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12282 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12283 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12284 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12285 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12286 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012287
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012288 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12289 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12290 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12291 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12292 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12293 a defaults section defining such rules.
12294
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012295 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012296 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12297 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012298
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012299 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12300 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12301 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12302 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12303 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12304 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12305
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012306 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012307 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12308 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12309 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12310 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12311 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12312 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12313 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12314 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12315 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12316 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012317
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012318 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012319 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12320 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12321 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012322
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012323 Example:
12324 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12325
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012326 Example:
12327
12328 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012329 tcp-request content set-var-fmt(sess.from) %[src]:%[src_port]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012330 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012331
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012332 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012333 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012334 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012335 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12336 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012337 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012338 tcp-request content reject
12339
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012340 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12341 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12342 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12343 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12344 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12345 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12346 ...
12347 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12348
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012349 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012350 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12351 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12352 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012353 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012354
12355 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12356 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
12357 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012358 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012359 tcp-request content reject
12360
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012361 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012362 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012363 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012364 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012365 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12366 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012367
12368 Example:
12369 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12370 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012371 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012372
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012373 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012374 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012375
12376 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012377 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012378 # protecting all our sites
12379 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012380 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12381 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012382 ...
12383 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12384
12385 backend http_dynamic
12386 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012387 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012388 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012389 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012390 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012391 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012392 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012393
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012394 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012395
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012396 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12397 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012398
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012399tcp-request content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12400
12401 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet27025602021-11-09 17:58:12 +010012402 rules are evaluated for the current section.
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012403
12404tcp-request content capture <sample> len <length>
12405 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12406
12407 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
12408 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
12409 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
12410 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
12411 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
12412 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
12413 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life. Please
12414 check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for more
12415 information.
12416
12417tcp-request content do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr>
12418
12419 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores the
12420 result in the variable <var>. Please refer to "http-request do-resolve" for a
12421 complete description.
12422
12423tcp-request content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12424
12425 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request content" rules
12426 are evaluated.
12427
12428tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12429tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12430tcp-request content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12431
12432 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12433 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12434 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12435 description.
12436
12437tcp-request content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12438 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12439tcp-request content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12440 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12441
12442 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12443 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12444 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
12445
12446tcp-request content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12448
12449 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12450 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
12451
12452tcp-request content set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12453tcp-request content set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12454
12455 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12456 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12457 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12458
12459tcp-request content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12460
12461 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12462 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
12463
12464tcp-request content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12465
12466 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12467 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12468 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12469
12470tcp-request content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12471
12472 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12473 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
12474
12475tcp-request content set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12476
12477 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request. Please
12478 refer to "http-request set-priority-class" for a complete description.
12479
12480tcp-request content set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12481
12482 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
12483 request. Please refer to "http-request set-priority-offset" for a complete
12484 description.
12485
Christopher Faulet1e83b702021-06-23 12:07:21 +020012486tcp-request content set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12487tcp-request content set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12488
12489 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12490 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12491 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12492
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012493tcp-request content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12494
12495 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12496 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12497 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12498
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012499tcp-request content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12500tcp-request content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012501
12502 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12503 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12504 for a complete description.
12505
12506tcp-request content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12507
12508 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12509 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12510 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12511 complete description.
12512
12513tcp-request content switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
12514 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12515
12516 This action is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP upgrades are
12517 supported for now. The protocol may optionally be specified. This action is
12518 only available for a proxy with the frontend capability. The connection
12519 upgrade is immediately performed, following "tcp-request content" rules are
12520 not evaluated. This upgrade method should be preferred to the implicit one
12521 consisting to rely on the backend mode. When used, it is possible to set HTTP
12522 directives in a frontend without any warning. These directives will be
12523 conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade is performed. However, an HTTP
12524 backend must still be selected. It remains unsupported to route an HTTP
12525 connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12526
12527 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12528
12529tcp-request content track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12530tcp-request content track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12531tcp-request content track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12532
12533 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12534 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12535 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12536
12537tcp-request content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12538
12539 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12540 details about variables.
12541
12542tcp-request content use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12543
12544 This action is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the request
12545 and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to reply by
12546 sending any valid response or it may immediately close the connection without
12547 sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible to write your own
12548 services in Lua. No further "tcp-request content" rules are evaluated.
12549
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012550
12551tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12552 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12553 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012554 yes(!) | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012555 Arguments :
12556 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12557 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12558 as explained at the top of this document.
12559
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012560 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012561 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12562 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12563 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12564 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12565
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012566 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12567 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12568 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12569 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12570
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012571 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012572 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012573 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012574 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012575 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012576 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12577 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12578 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012579
12580 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12581 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12582 it pass through unaffected.
12583
12584 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12585 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12586 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012587 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012588 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12589 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012590 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12591 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12592 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012593
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012594 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12595 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12596
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012597 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012598 "timeout client".
12599
12600
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012601tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12602 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012604 yes(!) | yes | yes | no
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012605 Arguments :
12606 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12607 below.
12608
12609 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12610
12611 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
12612 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12613 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12614 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
Anubhave09efaa2021-10-14 22:28:25 +053012615 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case is to copy some
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012616 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12617 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12618 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
12619 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
12620 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12621 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12622 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12623 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12624 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12625 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12626 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12627 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12628 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12629 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12630 instead.
12631
12632 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12633 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12634 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12635 rules which may be inserted.
12636
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012637 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12638 supported:
12639 - accept
12640 - reject
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012641 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12642 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12643 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12644 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12645 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012646 - set-dst <expr>
12647 - set-dst-port <expr>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012648 - set-mark <mark>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012649 - set-src <expr>
12650 - set-src-port <expr>
12651 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012652 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12653 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012654 - silent-drop
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012655 - track-sc0 <key> [table <table>]
12656 - track-sc1 <key> [table <table>]
12657 - track-sc2 <key> [table <table>]
12658 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012659
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012660 The supported actions are described below.
12661
12662 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12663 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12664 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12665 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12666 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12667 a defaults section defining such rules.
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012668
12669 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12670 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12671 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12672
12673 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12674 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12675 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12676 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12677 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12678
12679 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12680 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12681
12682 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12683 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12684 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12685
12686 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12687 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12688 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12689
12690 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12691 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12692 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12693
12694 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12695 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12696 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12697
12698 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12699
12700 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12701
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012702tcp-request session accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12703
12704 This is used to accept the connection. No further "tcp-request session"
12705 rules are evaluated.
12706
12707tcp-request session reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12708
12709 This is used to reject the connection. No further "tcp-request session" rules
12710 are evaluated.
12711
12712tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12713tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12714tcp-request session sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12715
12716 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12717 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12718 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12719 description.
12720
12721tcp-request session sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12722 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12723tcp-request session sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12724 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12725
12726 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12727 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "tcp-request connection
12728 sc-inc-gpt" and "tcp-request connection sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete
12729 description.
12730
12731tcp-request session set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12732tcp-request session set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12733
12734 These actions are used to set the destination IP/Port address to the value of
12735 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-dst" and
12736 "http-request set-dst-port" for a complete description.
12737
12738tcp-request session set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12739
12740 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12741 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12742 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
12743
12744tcp-request session set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12745tcp-request session set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12746
12747 These actions are used to set the source IP/Port address to the value of
12748 specified expression. Please refer to "http-request set-src" and
12749 "http-request set-src-port" for a complete description.
12750
12751tcp-request session set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12752
12753 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12754 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12755 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
12756
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012757tcp-request session set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12758tcp-request session set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012759
12760 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12761 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12762 for a complete description.
12763
12764tcp-request session silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12765
12766 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12767 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12768 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12769 complete description.
12770
12771tcp-request session track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12772tcp-request session track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12773tcp-request session track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12774
12775 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. Please
12776 refer to "http-request track-sc0", "http-request track-sc1" and "http-request
12777 track-sc2" for a complete description.
12778
12779tcp-request session unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12780
12781 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12782 details about variables.
12783
Christopher Faulet2468c212021-10-13 22:00:39 +020012784
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012785tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12786 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12787 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012788 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012789 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012790 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12791 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012792
12793 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12794
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012795 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012796 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12797 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012798 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12799 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012800
12801 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12802
12803 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12804 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12805 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12806 inserted.
12807
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012808 The first keyword is the rule's action. Several types of actions are
12809 supported:
12810 - accept
12811 - close
12812 - reject
12813 - sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>)
12814 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
12815 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
12816 - sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12817 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12818 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12819 - set-log-level <level>
12820 - set-mark <mark>
12821 - set-nice <nice>
12822 - set-tos <tos>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012823 - set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr>
12824 - set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt>
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012825 - silent-drop
12826 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12827
12828 The supported actions are described below.
12829
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012830 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12831 ones. Rules defined in the defaults section are evaluated before ones in the
12832 associated proxy section. To avoid ambiguities, in this case the same
12833 defaults section cannot be used by proxies with the frontend capability and
12834 by proxies with the backend capability. It means a listen section cannot use
12835 a defaults section defining such rules.
12836
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012837 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12838 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12839 for changing the default action to a reject.
12840
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012841 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012842
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012843 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12844 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12845 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12846 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
12847 period.
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012848
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012849 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012850
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012851 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
Christopher Faulet551a6412021-06-25 14:35:29 +020012852
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012853tcp-response content accept [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012854
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012855 This is used to accept the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12856 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet1da374a2021-06-25 14:46:02 +020012857
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012858tcp-response content close [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet469c06c2021-06-25 15:11:35 +020012859
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012860 This is used to immediately closes the connection with the server. No further
12861 "tcp-response content" rules are evaluated. The main purpose of this action
12862 is to force a connection to be finished between a client and a server after
12863 an exchange when the application protocol expects some long time outs to
12864 elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle connections which take
12865 significant resources on servers with certain protocols.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012866
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012867tcp-response content reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012868
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012869 This is used to reject the response. No further "tcp-response content" rules
12870 are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012871
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012872tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc(<idx>,<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12873tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12874tcp-response content sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020012875
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012876 These actions increment the General Purppose Counters according to the sticky
12877 counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request sc-inc-gpc",
12878 "http-request sc-inc-gpc0" and "http-request sc-inc-gpc1" for a complete
12879 description.
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012880
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012881tcp-response content sc-set-gpt(<idx>,<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12882 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12883tcp-resposne content sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12884 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012885
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012886 These actions set the 32-bit unsigned General Purpose Tags according to the
12887 sticky counter designated by <sc-id>. Please refer to "http-request
12888 sc-inc-gpt" and "http-request sc-inc-gpt0" for a complete description.
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020012889
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012890tcp-response content send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12891 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012892
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012893 Thaction is is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. Please
12894 refer to "http-request send-spoe-group" for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012895
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012896tcp-response content set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012897
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012898 This action is used to set the log level of the current session. Please refer
12899 to "http-request set-log-level". for a complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012900
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012901tcp-response content set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012902
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012903 This action is used to set the Netfilter/IPFW MARK in all packets sent to the
12904 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. Please
12905 refer to "http-request set-mark" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012906
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012907tcp-response content set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012908
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012909 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. Please
12910 refer to "http-request set-nice" for a complete description.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012911
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012912tcp-response content set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020012913
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012914 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
12915 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. Please refer to
12916 "http-request set-tos" for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012917
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010012918tcp-response content set-var(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
12919tcp-response content set-var-fmt(<var-name>[,<cond> ...]) <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012920
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012921 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
12922 inline. Please refer to "http-request set-var" and "http-request set-var-fmt"
12923 for a complete description.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012924
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012925tcp-response content silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012926
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012927 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
12928 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
12929 client from being notified. Please refer to "http-request silent-drop" for a
12930 complete description.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012931
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012932tcp-response content unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012933
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012934 This is used to unset a variable. Please refer to "http-request set-var" for
12935 details about variables.
12936
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012937
12938tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12939 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12940 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012941 yes(!) | no | yes | yes
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012942 Arguments :
12943 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12944 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12945 as explained at the top of this document.
12946
Christopher Faulet71d18922021-10-14 08:18:50 +020012947 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12948 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012949
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012950 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12951
12952
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012953timeout check <timeout>
12954 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12955 established.
12956
12957 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12958 yes | no | yes | yes
12959 Arguments:
12960 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12961 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12962 as explained at the top of this document.
12963
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012964 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012965 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012966 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012967 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012968 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12969 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12970 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012971
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012972 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012973 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12974
12975 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12976 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012977 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012978
12979 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12980 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12981 forget about it.
12982
Christopher Faulet6e0425b2021-10-13 19:27:38 +020012983 This directive is only available from named defaults sections, not anonymous
12984 ones. Proxies inherit this value from their defaults section.
12985
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012986 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12987 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012988
12989
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012990timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012991 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12992 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12993 yes | yes | yes | no
12994 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012995 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012996 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12997 as explained at the top of this document.
12998
12999 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13000 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13001 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010013002 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
13003 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
13004 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
13005 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013006 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
13007 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
13008 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013009 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013010 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013011 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
13012 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013013 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
13014 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013015
13016 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13017 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13018 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13019 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013020 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013021 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13022
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013023 This also applies to HTTP/2 connections, which will be closed with GOAWAY.
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013024
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013025 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013026
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013027
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013028timeout client-fin <timeout>
13029 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
13030 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13031 yes | yes | yes | no
13032 Arguments :
13033 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13034 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13035 as explained at the top of this document.
13036
13037 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
13038 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13039 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13040 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13041 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
13042 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13043 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010013044 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
13045 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
13046 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013047
13048 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
13049 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13050 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
13051
13052 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
13053
13054
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013055timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013056 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
13057 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13058 yes | no | yes | yes
13059 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013060 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013061 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13062 as explained at the top of this document.
13063
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013064 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013065 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013066 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013067 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010013068 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
13069 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013070
13071 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13072 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13073 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13074 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013075 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013076 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13077
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013078 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013079
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013080
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013081timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
13082 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
13083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13084 yes | yes | yes | yes
13085 Arguments :
13086 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13087 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13088 as explained at the top of this document.
13089
13090 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
13091 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
13092 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
13093 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
13094 once the request has started to present itself.
13095
13096 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
13097 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
13098 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
13099 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
13100 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
13101
13102 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
13103 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
13104 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
13105 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
13106
13107 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
13108 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013109 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013110 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
13111 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020013112 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013113
13114 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
13115 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
13116 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
13117 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
13118
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013119 When using HTTP/2 "timeout client" is applied instead. This is so we can keep
13120 using short keep-alive timeouts in HTTP/1.1 while using longer ones in HTTP/2
Lukas Tribus75df9d72017-11-24 19:05:12 +010013121 (where we only have one connection per client and a connection setup).
13122
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013123 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
13124
13125
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013126timeout http-request <timeout>
13127 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
13128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013129 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013130 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013131 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013132 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13133 as explained at the top of this document.
13134
13135 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
13136 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
13137 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
13138 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
13139 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
13140 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
13141 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020013142 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
13143 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
13144 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
13145 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013146 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013147 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
13148 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013149
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013150 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
13151 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
13152 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
13153 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
13154 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010013155 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013156
13157 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
13158 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013159 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013160 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
13161 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
13162
13163 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020013164 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
13165 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
13166 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013167
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020013168 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010013169 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013170
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013171
13172timeout queue <timeout>
13173 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
13174 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13175 yes | no | yes | yes
13176 Arguments :
13177 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13178 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13179 as explained at the top of this document.
13180
13181 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13182 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13183 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13184 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13185 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13186
13187 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13188 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13189 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13190 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13191
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013192 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013193
13194
13195timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013196 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13198 yes | no | yes | yes
13199 Arguments :
13200 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13201 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13202 as explained at the top of this document.
13203
13204 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13205 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13206 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13207 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13208 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13209 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13210 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13211
13212 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13213 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13214 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13215 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13216 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013217 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013218 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013219 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13220 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013221 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13222 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013223
13224 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13225 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13226 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13227 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013228 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013229 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13230
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013231 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013232
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013233
13234timeout server-fin <timeout>
13235 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13236 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13237 yes | no | yes | yes
13238 Arguments :
13239 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13240 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13241 as explained at the top of this document.
13242
13243 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13244 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13245 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13246 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13247 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13248 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13249 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13250 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13251 situations, it should not be needed.
13252
13253 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13254 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13255 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13256
13257 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13258
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013259
13260timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013261 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013262 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13263 yes | yes | yes | yes
13264 Arguments :
13265 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13266 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13267 as explained at the top of this document.
13268
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013269 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13270 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13271 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013272
13273 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13274 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13275 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13276 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013277 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013278
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013279 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013280
13281
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013282timeout tunnel <timeout>
13283 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13284 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13285 yes | no | yes | yes
13286 Arguments :
13287 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13288 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13289 as explained at the top of this document.
13290
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013291 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013292 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13293 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13294 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013295 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13296 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013297 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13298 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13299 specified.
13300
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013301 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13302 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13303 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13304 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13305 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13306 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13307 state.
13308
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013309 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13310 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13311 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13312 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013313 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013314
13315 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13316 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13317 forget about it.
13318
13319 Example :
13320 defaults http
13321 option http-server-close
13322 timeout connect 5s
13323 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013324 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013325 timeout server 30s
13326 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13327
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013328 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013329
13330
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013331transparent (deprecated)
13332 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13333 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013334 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013335 Arguments : none
13336
13337 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13338 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13339 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13340 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13341 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13342 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13343 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13344 appropriate server.
13345
13346 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13347
13348 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13349 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13350
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013351 See also: "option transparent"
13352
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013353unique-id-format <string>
13354 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13355 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13356 yes | yes | yes | no
13357 Arguments :
13358 <string> is a log-format string.
13359
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013360 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13361 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13362 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13363 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013364
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013365 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013366 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013367 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13368 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13369 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13370 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13371 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13372 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013373
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013374 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13375 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013376
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013377 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013378
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013379 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013380
13381 will generate:
13382
13383 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13384
13385 See also: "unique-id-header"
13386
13387unique-id-header <name>
13388 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13390 yes | yes | yes | no
13391 Arguments :
13392 <name> is the name of the header.
13393
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013394 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13395 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013396
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013397 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013398
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013399 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013400 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13401
13402 will generate:
13403
13404 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13405
13406 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013407
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013408use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013409 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013410 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13411 no | yes | yes | no
13412 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013413 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13414 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013415
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013416 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13417 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013418
13419 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13420 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13421 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013422 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013423 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013424 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13425 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013426
13427 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13428 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13429 assign the backend.
13430
13431 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13432 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13433 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13434 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13435 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13436 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13437
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013438 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013439 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013440 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13441 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13442 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13443
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013444 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13445 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13446 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13447 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13448 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13449 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13450 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13451 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13452 cannot be forced from the request.
13453
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013454 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013455 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13456 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13457
13458 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13459 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013460
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013461use-fcgi-app <name>
13462 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13463 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13464 no | no | yes | yes
13465 Arguments :
13466 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13467
13468 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013469
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013470use-server <server> if <condition>
13471use-server <server> unless <condition>
13472 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13473 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13474 no | no | yes | yes
13475 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013476 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13477 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013478
13479 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13480
13481 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13482 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13483 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13484
13485 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13486 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13487 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13488 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13489 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13490 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13491 matches will assign the server.
13492
13493 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13494 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13495 with the next rules until one matches.
13496
13497 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13498 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13499 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13500 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13501
13502 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13503 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13504 stripped.
13505
13506 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13507 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013508 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013509 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013510 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013511
13512 Example :
13513 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013514 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013515 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013516 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013517 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013518 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013519 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013520 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13521 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13522
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013523 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13524 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13525 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13526 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013527 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013528 and we fall back to load balancing.
13529
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013530 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013531
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013532
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100135335. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013534--------------------------
13535
13536The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13537depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13538settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13539written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13540described in this section.
13541
13542
135435.1. Bind options
13544-----------------
13545
13546The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13547as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13548no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13549parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13550while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13551provided immediately after the setting name.
13552
13553The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13554
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013555accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13556 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13557 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13558 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13559 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13560 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13561 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13562 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13563 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13564 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013565 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13566 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13567 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013568
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013569accept-proxy
13570 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013571 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13572 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013573 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13574 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13575 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13576 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013577 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013578 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13579 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013580 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13581 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013582
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013583allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013584 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013585 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013586 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013587 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13588 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013589
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013590alpn <protocols>
13591 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13592 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13593 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013594 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013595 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013596 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13597 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13598 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13599 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13600 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13601 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13602 preference, like below :
13603
13604 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013605
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013606backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013607 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013608 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13609
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013610curves <curves>
13611 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13612 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13613 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13614 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13615 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13616 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13617
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013618ecdhe <named curve>
13619 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013620 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13621 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013622
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013623ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013624 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13625 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13626 client's certificate.
13627
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013628ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13629 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13630 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13631 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13632 error is ignored.
13633
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013634ca-sign-file <cafile>
13635 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13636 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13637 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13638 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13639 'generate-certificates' for details.
13640
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013641ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013642 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13643 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13644 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13645 'generate-certificates' for details.
13646
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013647ca-verify-file <cafile>
13648 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13649 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13650 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13651 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13652 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13653
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013654ciphers <ciphers>
13655 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13656 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013657 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013658 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013659 information and recommendations see e.g.
13660 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13661 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13662 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13663
13664ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13665 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13666 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13667 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13668 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013669 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13670 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013671
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013672crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013673 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13674 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013675 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13676 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013677
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013678crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013679 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13680 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13681 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13682 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13683 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013684 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13685 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013686
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013687 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13688 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13689
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013690 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13691 are loaded.
13692
13693 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013694 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13695 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13696 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13697 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13698 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13699 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13700 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013701 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013702
13703 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13704 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13705 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13706 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013707 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13708 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013709
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013710 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013711
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013712 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013713 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013714 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13715 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013716 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13717 clients).
13718
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013719 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013720 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13721 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13722 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13723 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13724 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13725 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13726 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13727 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13728 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13729 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13730 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13731 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13732
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013733 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013734 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13735 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13736 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13737 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13738
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013739 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13740 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13741 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13742 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013743
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013744 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13745 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13746 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013747
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013748crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013749 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013750 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013751 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013752 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013753
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013754crt-list <file>
13755 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013756 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13757 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013758
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013759 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13760
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013761 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13762 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13763 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13764 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13765 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013766
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013767 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013768 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13769 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13770 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13771 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13772 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013773 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13774 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13775 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013776
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013777 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13778 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13779 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013780
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013781 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13782
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013783 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013784 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013785 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13786 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13787 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13788 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13789 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13790 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013791
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013792 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013793 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013794 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013795 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013796 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013797 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013798
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013799defer-accept
13800 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13801 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13802 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013803 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013804 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13805 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13806 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13807 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13808 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13809 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13810 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13811
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013812expose-fd listeners
13813 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13814 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemand2be557f2021-11-24 18:45:37 +010013815 In master-worker mode, this is not required anymore, the listeners will be
13816 passed using the internal socketpairs between the master and the workers.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013817 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013818
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013819force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013820 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013821 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013822 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013823 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013824
13825force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013826 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013827 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013828 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013829
13830force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013831 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013832 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013833 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013834
13835force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013836 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013837 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013838 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013839
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013840force-tlsv13
13841 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13842 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013843 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013844
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013845generate-certificates
13846 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13847 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13848 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13849 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13850 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13851 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13852 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13853 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13854 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13855 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13856 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13857
13858 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13859 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013860 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013861 certificate is used many times.
13862
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013863gid <gid>
13864 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13865 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13866 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13867 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13868 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13869
13870group <group>
13871 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13872 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13873 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13874 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13875 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13876
13877id <id>
13878 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13879 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13880 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13881 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13882
13883interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013884 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13885 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13886 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13887 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13888 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13889 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013890 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13891 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13892 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13893 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13894 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13895 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013896
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013897level <level>
13898 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13899 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13900 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013901 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013902 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13903 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13904 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013905 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013906 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013907 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013908 all counters).
13909
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013910severity-output <format>
13911 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13912 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13913 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13914 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13915 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13916 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13917 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13918 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13919 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13920 rfc5424 convention.
13921
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013922maxconn <maxconn>
13923 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13924 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13925 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13926 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13927 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13928 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13929 eat all memory.
13930
13931mode <mode>
13932 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13933 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13934 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13935 UNIX sockets.
13936
13937mss <maxseg>
13938 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13939 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13940 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13941 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13942 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13943 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13944 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13945 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13946 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13947 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13948 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13949
13950name <name>
13951 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13952 page.
13953
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013954namespace <name>
13955 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13956 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13957 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13958 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13959
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013960nice <nice>
13961 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13962 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13963 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13964 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13965 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13966 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13967 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13968 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13969 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13970 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13971 one for an RDP socket.
13972
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013973no-ca-names
13974 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13975 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013976 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013977
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013978no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013979 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013980 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013981 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013982 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013983 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13984 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013985
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013986no-tls-tickets
13987 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13988 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13989 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013990 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13991 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013992 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13993 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13994 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013995
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013996no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013997 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013998 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013999 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014000 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014001 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14002 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014003
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014004no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014005 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014006 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014007 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014008 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014009 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14010 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014011
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014012no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014013 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014014 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020014015 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014016 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014017 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14018 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014019
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014020no-tlsv13
14021 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14022 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
14023 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
14024 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014025 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
14026 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014027
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014028npn <protocols>
14029 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14030 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14031 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014032 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014033 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010014034 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14035 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
14036 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
14037 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
14038 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020014039
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014040prefer-client-ciphers
14041 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
14042 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
14043 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020014044 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
14045 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
14046 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000014047
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014048process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014049 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14050 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. Note
14051 that only process number 1 is permitted. If a thread set is specified, it
14052 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
14053 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
14054 repeated. <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010014055
14056 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14057
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014058 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020014059 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14060 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14061 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14062 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14063 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020014064
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014065 This directive is deprecated in favor of the more suited "thread" directive
14066 below, and will be removed in 2.7.
14067
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014068proto <name>
14069 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
14070 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
14071 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014072 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
14073 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14074
14075 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14076 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14077 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14078 also reported (flag=HTX).
14079
14080 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14081 a bind line :
14082
14083 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14084 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14085 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14086
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014087 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014088 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080014089 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020014090 h2" on the bind line.
14091
Willy Tarreau6dfbef42021-10-12 15:23:03 +020014092shards <number> | by-thread
14093 In multi-threaded mode, on operating systems supporting multiple listeners on
14094 the same IP:port, this will automatically create this number of multiple
14095 identical listeners for the same line, all bound to a fair share of the number
14096 of the threads attached to this listener. This can sometimes be useful when
14097 using very large thread counts where the in-kernel locking on a single socket
14098 starts to cause a significant overhead. In this case the incoming traffic is
14099 distributed over multiple sockets and the contention is reduced. Note that
14100 doing this can easily increase the CPU usage by making more threads work a
14101 little bit.
14102
14103 If the number of shards is higher than the number of available threads, it
14104 will automatically be trimmed to the number of threads (i.e. one shard per
14105 thread). The special "by-thread" value also creates as many shards as there
14106 are threads on the "bind" line. Since the system will evenly distribute the
14107 incoming traffic between all these shards, it is important that this number
14108 is an integral divisor of the number of threads.
14109
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014110ssl
14111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014112 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014113 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
14114 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020014115 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
14116 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014117
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014118ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
14119 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014120 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
14121 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
14122 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014123 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
14124
14125ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020014126 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
14127 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
14128 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
14129 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014130
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010014131strict-sni
14132 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
14133 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
14134 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
14135 See the "crt" option for more information.
14136
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014137tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014138 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014139 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014140 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014141 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010014142 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
14143 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
14144 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
14145 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
14146 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
14147 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
14148 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
14149
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014150tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010014151 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014152 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
14153 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
14154 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
14155 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
14156 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
14157 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
14158 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020014159 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
14160 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
14161 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020014162
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014163thread [<thread-group>/]<thread-set>
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014164 This restricts the list of threads on which this listener is allowed to run.
14165 It does not enforce any of them but eliminates those which do not match. It
14166 limits the threads allowed to process incoming connections for this listener.
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014167
14168 There are two numbering schemes. By default, thread numbers are absolute in
14169 the process, comprised between 1 and the value specified in global.nbthread.
14170 When thread groups are enabled, the number of a single desired thread group
14171 (starting at 1) may be specified before a slash ('/') before the thread
14172 range. In this case, the thread numbers in the range are relative to the
14173 thread group instead, and start at 1 for each thread group. Absolute and
14174 relative thread numbers may be used interchangeably but they must not be
14175 mixed on a single "bind" line, as those not set will be resolved at the end
14176 of the parsing.
14177
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014178 For the unlikely case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be
Willy Tarreaud57b9ff2021-09-29 18:50:31 +020014179 repeated. It is not permitted to use different thread groups even when using
14180 multiple directives. The <thread-set> specification must use the format:
Willy Tarreauc8cac042021-09-21 14:31:29 +020014181
14182 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
14183
14184 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such a
14185 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose is
14186 to have multiple bind lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same thread
14187 in a listener, so that the system can distribute the incoming connections
14188 into multiple queues, bypassing haproxy's internal queue load balancing.
14189 Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known for supporting this.
14190
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014191tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
14192 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010014193 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
14194 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
14195 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
14196 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
14197 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
14198 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
14199 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
14200 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
14201 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
14202 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010014203 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
14204 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
14205
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014206transparent
14207 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
14208 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
14209 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
14210 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
14211 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
14212 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
14213 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
14214 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
14215 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
14216 so check for support with your vendor.
14217
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014218v4v6
14219 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14220 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14221 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14222 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014223 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014224
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014225v6only
14226 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14227 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14228 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014229 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14230 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014231
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014232uid <uid>
14233 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14234 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14235 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14236 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14237 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14238
14239user <user>
14240 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14241 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14242 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14243 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14244 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14245
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014246verify [none|optional|required]
14247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14248 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14249 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14250 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14251 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014252 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14253 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14254 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14255 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014256
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200142575.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014258------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014259
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014260The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14261which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14262arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14263settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14264after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14265Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14266address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014267
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014268 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014269 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014270
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014271Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14272keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14273
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014274The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014275
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014276addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014277 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014278 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14279 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14280 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14281 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14282 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014283
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014284agent-check
14285 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014286 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014287 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14288 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14289 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014290
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014291 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014292 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014293 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014294 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14295 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014296
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014297 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14298 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14299 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14300 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14301 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014302
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014303 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014304 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014305
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014306 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14307 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14308 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014309
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014310 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14311 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14312 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014313
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014314 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014315 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14316 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14317 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14318 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014319 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014320 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014321
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014322 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14323 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014324
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014325 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14326 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14327 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14328 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14329 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14330 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14331 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14332 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14333 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014334
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014335 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14336 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014337 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14338 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14339 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014340 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014341
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014342 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014343 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014344
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014345agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014346 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014347 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14348 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14349 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14350 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14351
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014352agent-inter <delay>
14353 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14354 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14355
14356 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14357 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14358 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14359 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14360 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14361 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14362 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14363 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14364 of backends use the same servers.
14365
14366 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14367
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014368agent-addr <addr>
14369 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14370
14371 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014372 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014373 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14374 hostname, it will be resolved.
14375
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014376agent-port <port>
14377 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14378
14379 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14380
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014381allow-0rtt
14382 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014383 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14384 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014385
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014386alpn <protocols>
14387 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14388 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14389 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014390 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014391 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14392 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14393 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14394 now obsolete NPN extension.
14395 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14396 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14397
14398 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14399
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014400 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14401
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014402backup
14403 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14404 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14405 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14406 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014407 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14408 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014409
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014410ca-file <cafile>
14411 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14412 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14413 server's certificate.
14414
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014415check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014416 This option enables health checks on a server:
14417 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14418 considered available.
14419 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14420 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14421 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14422 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14423 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14424 set.
14425 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14426 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14427 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14428 exchanges succeed.
14429
14430 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14431 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14432 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14433 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14434 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014435 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014436 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14437
14438 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14439 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14440
14441 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14442 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14443
14444 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14445 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14446 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14447 available.
14448
14449 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14450 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14451 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14452
14453 Example:
14454 # simple tcp check
14455 backend foo
14456 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14457 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14458 backend foo
14459 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14460 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14461 backend foo
14462 option tcp-check
14463 tcp-check connect
14464 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014465
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014466check-send-proxy
14467 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14468 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14469 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14470 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14471 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14472 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14473 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14474
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014475check-alpn <protocols>
14476 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14477 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14478 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14479
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014480check-proto <name>
14481 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14482 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14483 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014484 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14485 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14486
14487 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14488 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14489 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14490 also reported (flag=HTX).
14491
14492 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14493 directive on a server line:
14494
14495 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14496 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14497 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14498 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14499
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014500 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014501 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14502 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14503
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014504check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014505 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014506 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14507 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014508
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014509check-ssl
14510 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14511 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14512 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14513 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014514 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014515 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14516 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014517 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014518 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14519 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014520
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014521check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014522 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014523 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14524 for normal traffic.
14525
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014526ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014527 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14528 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14529 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014530 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14531 information and recommendations see e.g.
14532 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14533 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14534 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014535
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014536ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14537 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14538 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14539 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14540 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014541 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14542 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14543 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014544
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014545cookie <value>
14546 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14547 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14548 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14549 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14550 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14551 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14552 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14553
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014554crl-file <crlfile>
14555 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14556 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14557 to verify server's certificate.
14558
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014559crt <cert>
14560 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14561 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14562 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14563 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14564 certificate request.
14565
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014566 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14567 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14568 option is set accordingly).
14569
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014570disabled
14571 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14572 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14573 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14574 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14575 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014576 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014577
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014578enabled
14579 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14580 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14581 default value.
14582 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14583 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014584
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014585error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014586 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14587 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14588 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014589
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014590 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014591
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014592fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014593 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14594 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14595 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14596
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014597force-sslv3
14598 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14599 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014600 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014601 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014602
14603force-tlsv10
14604 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014605 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014606 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014607
14608force-tlsv11
14609 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014610 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014611 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014612
14613force-tlsv12
14614 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014615 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014616 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014617
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014618force-tlsv13
14619 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14620 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014621 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014622
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014623id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014624 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14625 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14626 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014627
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014628init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14629 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14630 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014631 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014632 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14633 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14634 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14635 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14636 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14637 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14638 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14639 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14640 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014641 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014642 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14643 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14644 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14645 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14646 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14647 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014648 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014649
14650 Example:
14651 defaults
14652 # never fail on address resolution
14653 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14654
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014655inter <delay>
14656fastinter <delay>
14657downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014658 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14659 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14660 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14661 between checks depending on the server state :
14662
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014663 Server state | Interval used
14664 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14665 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14666 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14667 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14668 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14669 or yet unchecked. |
14670 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14671 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14672 | "inter" otherwise.
14673 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014674
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014675 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14676 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14677 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14678 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014679 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14680 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14681 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14682 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14683 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014684
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014685log-proto <logproto>
14686 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14687 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14688 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14689 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14690
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014691maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014692 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14693 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014694 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14695 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014696 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14697 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14698 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14699 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14700
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014701 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14702 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14703 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14704 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14705 than 50 concurrent requests.
14706
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014707maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014708 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14709 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14710 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14711 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014712 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14713 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14714 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14715 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14716 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14717 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14718 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014719
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014720max-reuse <count>
14721 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14722 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14723 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14724 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14725 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14726 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14727 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14728 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14729
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014730minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014731 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14732 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14733 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14734 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14735 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14736 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014737 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014738 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014739
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014740namespace <name>
14741 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14742 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14743 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14744 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14745
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014746no-agent-check
14747 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14748 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14749 default value.
14750 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14751 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14752
14753no-backup
14754 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14755 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14756 default value.
14757 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14758 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14759
14760no-check
14761 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14762 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14763 default value.
14764 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14765 "default-server" "check" setting.
14766
14767no-check-ssl
14768 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14769 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14770 default value.
14771 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14772 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14773
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014774no-send-proxy
14775 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14776 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14777 default value.
14778 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14779 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14780
14781no-send-proxy-v2
14782 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14783 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14784 default value.
14785 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14786 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14787
14788no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14789 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14790 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14791 default value.
14792 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14793 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14794
14795no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14796 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14797 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14798 default value.
14799 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14800 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14801
14802no-ssl
14803 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14804 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14805 default value.
14806 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14807 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14808
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014809 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14810 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14811 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14812
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014813no-ssl-reuse
14814 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14815 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14816 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14817 and for paranoid users.
14818
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014819no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014820 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14821 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014822 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014823
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014824 Supported in default-server: No
14825
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014826no-tls-tickets
14827 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14828 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14829 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014830 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14831 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014832 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14833 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14834 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014835 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014836
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014837no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014838 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014839 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14840 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014841 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14842 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014843 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014844
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014845 Supported in default-server: No
14846
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014847no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014848 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014849 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14850 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014851 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14852 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014853 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014854
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014855 Supported in default-server: No
14856
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014857no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014858 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014859 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14860 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014861 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14862 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014863 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014864
14865 Supported in default-server: No
14866
14867no-tlsv13
14868 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14869 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14870 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14871 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14872 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014873 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014874
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014875 Supported in default-server: No
14876
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014877no-verifyhost
14878 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14879 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14880 default value.
14881 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14882 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014883
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014884no-tfo
14885 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14886 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14887 default value.
14888 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14889 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14890
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014891non-stick
14892 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14893 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14894 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14895
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014896npn <protocols>
14897 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14898 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14899 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014900 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014901 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14902 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14903 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14904
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014905observe <mode>
14906 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14907 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14908 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14909 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14910 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14911 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014912 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014913
14914 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14915
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014916on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014917 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14918 Currently, four modes are available:
14919 - fastinter: force fastinter
14920 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14921 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14922 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14923 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14924
14925 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14926
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014927on-marked-down <action>
14928 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14929 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014930 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14931 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14932 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14933 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14934 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14935 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14936 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14937 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014938
14939 Actions are disabled by default
14940
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014941on-marked-up <action>
14942 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14943 Currently one action is available:
14944 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14945 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14946 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14947 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014948 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14949 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014950 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14951 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14952
14953 Actions are disabled by default
14954
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014955pool-low-conn <max>
14956 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14957 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14958 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14959 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14960 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14961 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14962 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14963 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14964 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14965 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014966 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14967 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14968 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14969 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014970
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014971pool-max-conn <max>
14972 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14973 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14974 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14975 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14976 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14977 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14978
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014979pool-purge-delay <delay>
14980 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014981 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014982 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014983
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014984port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014985 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014986 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14987 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14988 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14989 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14990 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014991
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014992proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014993 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14994 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14995 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014996 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14997 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14998
14999 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
15000 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
15001 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
15002 also reported (flag=HTX).
15003
15004 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
15005 a server line :
15006
15007 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15008 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
15009 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
15010 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
15011
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040015012 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020015013 protocol for all connections established to this server.
15014
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015015 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
15016
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015017redir <prefix>
15018 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
15019 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
15020 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
15021 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
15022 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
15023 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
15024 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
15025 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015026 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015027 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015028 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
15029 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
15030 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
15031 loop between the client and HAProxy!
15032
15033 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
15034
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015035rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015036 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
15037 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
15038 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
15039
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015040resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
15041 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
15042 server.
15043
15044 Available options:
15045
15046 * allow-dup-ip
15047 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
15048 resolution at runtime is in operation.
15049 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
15050 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
15051 For such case, simply enable this option.
15052 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
15053
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050015054 * ignore-weight
15055 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
15056 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
15057 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
15058
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020015059 * prevent-dup-ip
15060 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
15061 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
15062 same fqdn.
15063 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
15064
15065 Example:
15066 backend b_myapp
15067 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
15068 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15069 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
15070
15071 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
15072 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
15073 it
15074 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
15075 different address
15076
15077 Default value: not set
15078
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015079resolve-prefer <family>
15080 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
15081 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
15082 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
15083 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
15084
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020015085 Default value: ipv6
15086
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015087 Example:
15088
15089 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015090
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015091resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015092 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015093 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010015094 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015095 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
15096 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015097 configured network, another address is selected.
15098
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015099 Example:
15100
15101 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010015102
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015103resolvers <id>
15104 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
15105 hostname.
15106
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015107 Example:
15108
15109 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015110
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015111 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015112
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015113send-proxy
15114 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
15115 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
15116 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
15117 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015118 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
15119 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
15120 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
15121 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015122 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015123 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
15124 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
15125 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
15126 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
15127 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015128 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
15129 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010015130
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015131send-proxy-v2
15132 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
15133 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15134 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15135 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020015136 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
15137 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
15138 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
15139 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015140
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015141proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010015142 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
15143 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
15144
15145 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
15146 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
15147 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
15148 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
15149 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
15150 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
15151 connection is supported).
15152 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
15153 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
15154 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
15155 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
15156 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
15157 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
15158 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010015159
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015160send-proxy-v2-ssl
15161 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15162 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15163 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15164 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15165 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15166 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
15167 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015168 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
15169 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015170
15171send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
15172 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
15173 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
15174 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
15175 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
15176 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
15177 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
15178 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
15179 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015180 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
15181 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040015182
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015183slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015184 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
15185 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
15186 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
15187 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
15188 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
15189 parameters :
15190
15191 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
15192 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
15193
15194 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
15195 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
15196 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
15197 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
15198
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015199 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015200 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
15201 seen as failed.
15202
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015203sni <expression>
15204 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
15205 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
15206 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
15207 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020015208 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
15209 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015210 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010015211 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
15212 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020015213
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015214source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020015215source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015216source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015217 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15218 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15219 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15220 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15221
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015222 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15223 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15224 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15225 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15226 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15227 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15228 server.
15229
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015230 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15231 specifying the source address without port(s).
15232
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015233ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015234 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15235 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15236 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15237 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15238 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15239 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015240 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15241 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015242
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015243ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15244 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15245 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15246 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15247
15248ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15249 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15250 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15251 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15252
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015253ssl-reuse
15254 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15255 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15256 default value.
15257 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15258 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15259
15260stick
15261 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15262 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15263 default value.
15264 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15265 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015266
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015267socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015268 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015269 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15270 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15271
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015272tcp-ut <delay>
15273 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015274 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015275 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015276 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015277 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15278 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15279 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15280 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15281 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15282 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15283 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15284 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15285 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15286
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015287tfo
15288 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15289 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15290 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15291 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015292 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015293 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015294
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015295track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015296 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15297 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15298 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15299 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015300 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15301
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015302tls-tickets
15303 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15304 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15305 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015306 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15307 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15308 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015309 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015310 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015311
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015312verify [none|required]
15313 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015314 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015315 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15316 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015317 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015318 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15319 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15320 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15321 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15322 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15323 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15324 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15325 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015326
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015327verifyhost <hostname>
15328 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015329 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15330 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15331 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15332 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15333 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15334 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15335 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15336 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015337
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015338weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015339 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15340 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15341 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015342 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15343 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15344 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15345 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15346 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15347 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015348
Amaury Denoyellef9d59572021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015349ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15350 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15351 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15352 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15353
15354 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15355 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15356 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15357 server ALPN contains it.
15358
15359 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15360 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15361 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15362 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15363
15364 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15365 favor of the ALPN extension.
15366
15367 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15368
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015369
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153705.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15371-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015372
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015373HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15374using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015375configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015376This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15377can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15378workload.
15379This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15380resolution at run time.
15381Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15382carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15383
15384
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200153855.3.1. Global overview
15386----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015387
15388As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15389different steps of the process life:
15390
15391 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15392 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15393 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15394
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015395 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15396 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015397
15398A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15399 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15400 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15401 resolution to know this new IP.
15402
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015403When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015404HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015405SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15406from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015407will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015408will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015409
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015410A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015411 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015412 first valid response.
15413
15414 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15415 servers return an error.
15416
15417
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200154185.3.2. The resolvers section
15419----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015420
15421This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015422HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15423contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015424
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015425When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15426uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15427is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15428answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15429
15430When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015431used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015432
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015433 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15434 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15435 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015436
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015437 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15438 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015439
Thierry Fournier55c40ea2021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015440 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015441 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15442 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015443
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015444For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15445following scenarios are possible:
15446
15447 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15448 ignored
15449
15450 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15451 applied
15452
15453 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15454 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15455
15456 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15457 retries the query with a new type
15458
15459 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15460 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015461
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015462As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015463a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015464<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015465
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015466
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015467resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015468 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015469
15470A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15471
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015472accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015473 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015474 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015475 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15476 by RFC 6891)
15477
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015478 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15479 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15480 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15481 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15482 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15483 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015484
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015485nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15486 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15487 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15488 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15489 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15490 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15491 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15492 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15493 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15494 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015495 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15496
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015497parse-resolv-conf
15498 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15499 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15500 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15501
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015502hold <status> <period>
15503 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15504 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015505 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015506 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015507 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15508 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15509 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15510
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015511 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015512
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015513resolve_retries <nb>
15514 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15515 giving up.
15516 Default value: 3
15517
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015518 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15519 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15520 type.
15521
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015522timeout <event> <time>
15523 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15524 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15525 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015526 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15527 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015528 Default value: 1s
15529 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015530 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015531 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015532 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15533 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15534
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015535 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015536
15537 resolvers mydns
15538 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15539 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015540 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015541 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015542 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015543 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015544 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015545 hold other 30s
15546 hold refused 30s
15547 hold nx 30s
15548 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015549 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015550 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015551
15552
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200155536. Cache
15554---------
15555
15556HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15557(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15558RAM.
15559
Willy Tarreau317804d2021-06-15 11:35:31 +020015560The cache is based on a memory area shared between all threads, and split in 1kB
15561blocks.
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015562
15563If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15564independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15565when we try to allocate a new one.
15566
15567The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15568
15569It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15570"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15571for more details.
15572
15573When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15574replaced by "<CACHE>".
15575
15576
155776.1. Limitation
15578----------------
15579
15580The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15581
15582- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015583- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15584 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15585 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015586- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15587- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015588- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15589 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15590 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015591- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15592 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015593- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15594 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15595 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015596
15597- If the request is not a GET
15598- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15599- If the request contains an Authorization header
15600
15601
156026.2. Setup
15603-----------
15604
15605To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15606the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15607
15608
156096.2.1. Cache section
15610---------------------
15611
15612cache <name>
15613 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15614 size of cache is mandatory.
15615
15616total-max-size <megabytes>
15617 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15618 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15619
15620max-object-size <bytes>
15621 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15622 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15623 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15624
15625max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015626 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015627 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15628 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15629 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15630 default.
15631
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015632process-vary <on/off>
15633 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015634 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15635 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15636 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015637 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015638
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015639max-secondary-entries <number>
15640 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15641 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15642 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15643
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015644
156456.2.2. Proxy section
15646---------------------
15647
15648http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15649 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15650 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15651 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15652 after this one.
15653
15654http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15655 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15656 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15657 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15658 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15659
15660
15661Example:
15662
15663 backend bck1
15664 mode http
15665
15666 http-request cache-use foobar
15667 http-response cache-store foobar
15668 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15669
15670 cache foobar
15671 total-max-size 4
15672 max-age 240
15673
15674
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200156757. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15676----------------------------------
15677
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015678HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015679client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15680The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15681these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15682but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15683data called patterns.
15684
15685
156867.1. ACL basics
15687---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015688
15689The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15690content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15691from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15692simple :
15693
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015694 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015695 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015696 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15697 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015698
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015699The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15700adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015701
15702In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15703
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015704 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015705
15706This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15707Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15708and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015709an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15710conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15711as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15712are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015713
15714ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15715'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15716which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15717
15718There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15719performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15722specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15723this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015724methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15725ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015726
15727Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15728 - boolean
15729 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15730 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15731 - string
15732 - data block
15733
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015734Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15735converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15736would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15737The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15738which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15739
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015740Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15741keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15742fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15743which are summarized in the table below :
15744
15745 +---------------------+-----------------+
15746 | Sample or converter | Default |
15747 | output type | matching method |
15748 +---------------------+-----------------+
15749 | boolean | bool |
15750 +---------------------+-----------------+
15751 | integer | int |
15752 +---------------------+-----------------+
15753 | ip | ip |
15754 +---------------------+-----------------+
15755 | string | str |
15756 +---------------------+-----------------+
15757 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15758 +---------------------+-----------------+
15759
15760Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15761matching method, see below.
15762
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015763The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15764 - boolean
15765 - integer or integer range
15766 - IP address / network
15767 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15768 - regular expression
15769 - hex block
15770
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015771The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15772
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015773 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15774 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015775 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015776 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015777 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015778 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015779 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15780
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015781The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15782read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15783if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15784lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15785will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15786beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015787a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015788lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15789exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15790
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015791The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15792parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15793ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15794a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15795check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15796
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015797The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15798socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15799file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015801Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15802loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15803
15804 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15805
15806In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15807the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15808case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15809as well.
15810
15811The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15812sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15813do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15814methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15815is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015816obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015817followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15818default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15819that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15820string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15821
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015822The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15823By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15824string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15825resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015826server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015827waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015828flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15829function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15830
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015831There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15832sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15833be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015834
15835 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15836 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015837 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15838 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15839 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15840 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015841
15842 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15843 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015844 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015845
15846 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015847 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015848
15849 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015850 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015851
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015852 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015853 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15854
15855 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15856 binary or string samples.
15857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015858 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15859 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015860
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015861 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15862 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15863 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015865 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15866 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015868 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15869 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015871 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15872 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015873
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015874 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15875 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015876 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015878 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15879 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15880 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015881
15882For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15883request, it is possible to do :
15884
15885 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
15886
15887In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15888buffer, one would use the following acl :
15889
15890 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
15891
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015892On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15893possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15894
15895 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
15896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015897All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15898criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15899method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15900to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15901criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15902the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015905the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15906For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015907
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015908 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15909 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15910 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15911 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015912
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015913
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015914The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15915types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15916combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15917brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15918default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015920 +-------------------------------------------------+
15921 | Input sample type |
15922 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015923 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015924 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15925 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15926 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015927 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015928 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015929 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015930 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015931 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015932 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015933 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015934 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015935 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015936 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015937 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015938 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015939 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015940 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015941 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015942 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015943 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015944 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015945 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015946 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015947 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015948 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15949 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15950 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015951
15952
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159537.1.1. Matching booleans
15954------------------------
15955
15956In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15957Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15958When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15959that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15960
15961Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15962return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15963"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15964
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015965
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200159667.1.2. Matching integers
15967------------------------
15968
15969Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15970enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15971to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15972
15973Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15974matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15975lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015976
15977For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15978unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15979representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15980
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015981As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15982two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15983instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15984ranges and operators.
15985
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015986For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015987operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15988Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15989of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015990
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015991Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015992
15993 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15994 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15995 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15996 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15997 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15998
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015999For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016000
16001 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
16002
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020016003This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
16004
16005 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
16006
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016007
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160087.1.3. Matching strings
16009-----------------------
16010
16011String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
16012different forms :
16013
16014 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016015 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016016
16017 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016018 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016019
16020 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
16021 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16022
16023 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
16024 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
16025
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010016026 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016027 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
16028 matches.
16029
16030 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
16031 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
16032 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016033
16034String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
16035exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
16036characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
16037string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
16038to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016039before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016040
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010016041Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
16042(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
16043Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
16044
16045Example:
16046 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
16047 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
16048
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016049
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160507.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
16051---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016052
16053Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
16054they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
16055possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
16056passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
16057the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016058the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
16059match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016060
16061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200160627.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
16063-------------------------------------
16064
16065It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
16066not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
16067a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
16068to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
16069digits may be used upper or lower case.
16070
16071Example :
16072 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
16073 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
16074
16075
160767.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
16077---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016078
16079IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
16080netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
16081within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010016082host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016083difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
16084at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
16085does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
16086parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016087
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020016088The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
16089abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
16090
16091 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16092 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
16093 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16094 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
16095 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
16096 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
16097 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
16098 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
16099
16100Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
16101192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
16102
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020016103IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
16104Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
16105trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
16106IPv6 patterns.
16107
16108HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
16109following situations :
16110 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
16111 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
16112 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
16113 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
16114 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
16115 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
16116 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
16117 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
16118 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
16119 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
16120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016121
161227.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
16123----------------------------------
16124
16125Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
16126combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
16127
16128 - AND (implicit)
16129 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
16130 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016131
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016132A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020016133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016134 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016135
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016136Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
16137indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020016138
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016139For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
16140"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
16141requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
16142is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
16143
16144 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016145 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
16146 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
16147 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016148
16149To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
16150and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
16151
16152 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
16153 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
16154 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
16155 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
16156
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016157 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016158 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
16159 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
16160 use_backend www if host_www
16161
16162It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
16163expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
16164be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
16165the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
16166
16167 The following rule :
16168
16169 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016170 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016171
16172 Can also be written that way :
16173
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016174 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016175
16176It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
16177to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
16178simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
16179sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
16180good use is the following :
16181
16182 With named ACLs :
16183
16184 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
16185 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
16186 monitor fail if site_dead
16187
16188 With anonymous ACLs :
16189
16190 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
16191
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030016192See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
16193keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016194
16195
161967.3. Fetching samples
16197---------------------
16198
16199Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
16200against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
16201sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
16202ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
16203of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
16204available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
16205
16206This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
16207Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
16208compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
16209deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
16210
16211The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
16212matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
16213method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
16214indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
16215
16216As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16217when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16218mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16219the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16220ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16221
16222Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16223multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16224when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016225incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16226are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016227is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16228all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16229
16230Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16231 - name
16232 - name(arg1)
16233 - name(arg1,arg2)
16234
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016235
162367.3.1. Converters
16237-----------------
16238
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016239Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16240of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16241is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16242was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016243has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016244unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16245
16246These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16247sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16248the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016249support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016250
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016251A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16252support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16253supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16254(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16255bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016257The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016258
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001625951d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16260 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16261 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16262 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16263 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16264 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16265
16266 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016267 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16268 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016269 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16270 frontend http-in
16271 bind *:8081
16272 default_backend servers
16273 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16274 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16275
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016276add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016277 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016278 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016279 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16280 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016281 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016282 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16283 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16284 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16285 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016286 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016287 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016288
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016289aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16290 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16291 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16292 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16293 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16294 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16295 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16296
16297 Example:
16298 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16299 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16300
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016301and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016302 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016303 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016304 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16305 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016306 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016307 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16308 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16309 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16310 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016311 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016312 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016313
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016314b64dec
16315 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16316 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016317 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16318 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016319
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016320base64
16321 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016322 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016323 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16324 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016325
Marcin Deranek40ca09c2021-07-13 14:05:24 +020016326be2dec(<separator>,<chunk_size>,[<truncate>])
16327 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a string containing an unsigned
16328 integer number per <chunk_size> input bytes. <separator> is put every
16329 <chunk_size> binary input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates
16330 whatever binary input is truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries. <chunk_size>
16331 maximum value is limited by the size of long long int (8 bytes).
16332
16333 Example:
16334 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(:,2) # 258:772:1286:7
16335 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(-,2,1) # 258-772-1286
16336 bin(01020304050607),be2dec(,2,1) # 2587721286
16337 bin(7f000001),be2dec(.,1) # 127.0.0.1
16338
Marcin Deranekda0264a2021-07-13 14:08:56 +020016339be2hex([<separator>],[<chunk_size>],[<truncate>])
16340 Converts big-endian binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex
16341 digits per input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some
16342 binary input data in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID
16343 can be copied in a header). <separator> is put every <chunk_size> binary
16344 input bytes if specified. <truncate> flag indicates whatever binary input is
16345 truncated at <chunk_size> boundaries.
16346
16347 Example:
16348 bin(01020304050607),be2hex # 01020304050607
16349 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(:,2) # 0102:0304:0506:07
16350 bin(01020304050607),be2hex(--,2,1) # 0102--0304--0506
16351 bin(0102030405060708),be2hex(,3,1) # 010203040506
16352
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016353bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016354 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016355 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016356 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016357 presence of a flag).
16358
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016359bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16360 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16361 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016362 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016363
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016364concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16365 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16366 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16367 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16368 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16369 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16370 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16371 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16372 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16373 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16374 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016375 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016376 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016377 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016378 level parser. This is often used to build composite variables from other
16379 ones, but sometimes using a format string with multiple fields may be more
16380 convenient. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016381
16382 Example:
16383 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16384 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16385 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016386 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau9a621ae2021-09-02 21:00:38 +020016387 tcp-request session set-var-fmt(txn.ipport) "addr=(%[sess.ip],%[sess.port])" ## does the same
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016388 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16389
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016390cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016391 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16392 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016393
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016394crc32([<avalanche>])
16395 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16396 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16397 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16398 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16399 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16400 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16401 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16402 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16403 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16404 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016405 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16406
16407crc32c([<avalanche>])
16408 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16409 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16410 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16411 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16412 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16413 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16414 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16415 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016416
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016417cut_crlf
16418 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16419 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16420 updated.
16421
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016422da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016423 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16424 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16425 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16426 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016427 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016428 configuration language.
16429
16430 Example:
16431 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016432 bind *:8881
16433 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016434 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016435
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016436debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16437 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16438 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16439 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16440 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16441 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16442 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16443 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16444 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16445 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16446 printable sample types.
16447
16448 Example:
16449 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016450
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016451digest(<algorithm>)
16452 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16453 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16454
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016455 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016456 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16457
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016458div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016459 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16460 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016461 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016462 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16463 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016464 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016465 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16466 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16467 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16468 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016469 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016470 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016471
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016472djb2([<avalanche>])
16473 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16474 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16475 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16476 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16477 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16478 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16479 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016480 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16481 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016482
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016483even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016484 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016485 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16486
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016487field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16488 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16489 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16490 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16491 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16492 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16493 fields.
16494
16495 Example :
16496 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16497 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16498 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16499 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16500 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016501
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016502fix_is_valid
16503 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16504 Information eXchange):
16505
16506 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16507 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016508 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016509 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016510 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016511 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16512 checksum
16513
16514 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16515 the server can be parsed.
16516
16517 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16518 message, false if not.
16519
16520 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16521
16522 Example:
16523 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16524 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16525
16526fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16527 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16528 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16529 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16530 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016531 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016532 added.
16533
16534 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16535 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16536 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16537 fix_is_valid converter.
16538
16539 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16540
16541 Example:
16542 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16543 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16544 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16545 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16546 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16547
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016548hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016549 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016550 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016551 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016552 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016553
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016554hex2i
16555 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016556 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016557
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016558htonl
16559 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16560 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16561 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16562 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16563
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016564hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016565 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16566 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16567 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16568 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16569
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016570 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016571 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16572
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016573http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016574 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16575 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016576 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16577 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16578 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16579 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16580 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16581 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16582 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16583 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016584
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016585iif(<true>,<false>)
16586 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16587 string otherwise.
16588
16589 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016590 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016591
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016592in_table(<table>)
16593 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16594 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16595 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016596 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016597 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16598
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016599ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016600 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016601 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016602 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16603 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16604 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16605 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16606 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016607
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016608json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016609 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016610 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016611 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016612 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16613 of errors:
16614 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16615 bytes, ...)
16616 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16617 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16618
16619 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16620 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16621 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16622 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16623 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16624 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016625 - "ascii" : never fails;
16626 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16627 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016628 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016629 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016630 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16631 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16632
16633 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016634 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016635
16636 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016637 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016638 capture request header user-agent len 150
16639 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016640
16641 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16642 GET / HTTP/1.0
16643 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16644
16645 Output log:
16646 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16647
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016648json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16649 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16650 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16651 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16652 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16653
16654 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16655 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16656
16657 Example:
16658 # get a integer value from the request body
16659 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16660 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16661
16662 # get a key with '.' in the name
16663 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16664 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16665
16666 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16667 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16668
16669 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16670 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16671
Remi Tricot-Le Breton0a72f5e2021-10-01 15:36:57 +020016672jwt_header_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16673 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded header
16674 part of the token (the first base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if no
16675 parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded header part of
16676 the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16677 json_path and output_type parameters.
16678
16679 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16680 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16681
16682jwt_payload_query([<json_path>],[<output_type>])
16683 When given a JSON Web Token (JWT) in input, either returns the decoded
16684 payload part of the token (the second base64-url encoded part of the JWT) if
16685 no parameter is given, or performs a json_query on the decoded payload part
16686 of the token. See "json_query" converter for details about the accepted
16687 json_path and output_type parameters.
16688
16689 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16690 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16691
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016692jwt_verify(<alg>,<key>)
16693 Performs a signature verification for the JSON Web Token (JWT) given in input
16694 by using the <alg> algorithm and the <key> parameter, which should either
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016695 hold a secret or a path to a public certificate. Returns 1 in case of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016696 verification success, 0 in case of verification error and a strictly negative
16697 value for any other error. Because of all those non-null error return values,
16698 the result of this converter should never be converted to a boolean. See
16699 below for a full list of the possible return values.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016700
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016701 For now, only JWS tokens using the Compact Serialization format can be
16702 processed (three dot-separated base64-url encoded strings). Among the
16703 accepted algorithms for a JWS (see section 3.1 of RFC7518), the PSXXX ones
16704 are not managed yet.
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016705
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016706 If the used algorithm is of the HMAC family, <key> should be the secret used
16707 in the HMAC signature calculation. Otherwise, <key> should be the path to the
16708 public certificate that can be used to validate the token's signature. All
16709 the certificates that might be used to verify JWTs must be known during init
16710 in order to be added into a dedicated certificate cache so that no disk
16711 access is required during runtime. For this reason, any used certificate must
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016712 be mentioned explicitly at least once in a jwt_verify call. Passing an
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016713 intermediate variable as second parameter is then not advised.
16714
16715 This converter only verifies the signature of the token and does not perform
16716 a full JWT validation as specified in section 7.2 of RFC7519. We do not
16717 ensure that the header and payload contents are fully valid JSON's once
16718 decoded for instance, and no checks are performed regarding their respective
16719 contents.
16720
16721 The possible return values are the following :
16722
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016723 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
16724 | ID | message |
16725 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016726 | 0 | "Verification failure" |
Ilya Shipitsina4d09e72021-11-20 23:11:12 +050016727 | 1 | "Verification success" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1c891bc2021-10-18 15:14:49 +020016728 | -1 | "Unknown algorithm (not mentioned in RFC7518)" |
16729 | -2 | "Unmanaged algorithm (PSXXX algorithm family)" |
16730 | -3 | "Invalid token" |
16731 | -4 | "Out of memory" |
16732 | -5 | "Unknown certificate" |
Willy Tarreau0eba94e2021-10-15 11:48:42 +020016733 +----+----------------------------------------------------------------------+
Remi Tricot-Le Breton130e1422021-10-01 15:36:58 +020016734
16735 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
16736 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16737
16738 Example:
16739 # Get a JWT from the authorization header, extract the "alg" field of its
16740 # JOSE header and use a public certificate to verify a signature
16741 http-request set-var(txn.bearer) http_auth_bearer
16742 http-request set-var(txn.jwt_alg) var(txn.bearer),jwt_header_query('$.alg')
16743 http-request deny unless { var(txn.jwt_alg) "RS256" }
16744 http-request deny unless { var(txn.bearer),jwt_verify(txn.jwt_alg,"/path/to/crt.pem") 1 }
16745
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016746language(<value>[,<default>])
16747 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16748 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16749 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16750 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16751 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16752 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16753 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16754 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16755 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016756 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016757 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16758 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016759
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016760 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016761
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016762 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16763 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016764
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016765 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16766 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16767 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16768 use_backend spanish if es
16769 use_backend french if fr
16770 use_backend english if en
16771 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016772
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016773length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016774 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16775 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16776 type. The result is of type integer.
16777
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016778lower
16779 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16780 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16781 type. The result is of type string.
16782
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016783ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16784 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16785 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16786 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16787 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16788 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16789 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16790
16791 Example :
16792
16793 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016794 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016795 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16796
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016797ltrim(<chars>)
16798 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16799 representation of the input sample.
16800
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016801map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16802map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16803map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16804 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16805 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16806 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16807 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16808 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16809 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16810 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16811 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016812
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016813 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16814 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16815 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016816
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016817 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016818 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016819
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016820 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16821 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16822 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16823 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016824 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16825 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016826 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16827 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16828 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16829 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16830 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16831 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16832 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16833 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016834 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16835 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16836 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016837 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16838 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16839 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16840 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16841 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016842
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016843 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16844 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16845 the corresponding match text.
16846
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016847 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16848 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16849 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16850 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16851 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016852
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016853 Example :
16854
16855 # this is a comment and is ignored
16856 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16857 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16858 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16859 | | | `---------- value
16860 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16861 | `---------------------------- key
16862 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16863
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016864mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016865 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16866 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016867 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016868 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016869 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016870 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16871 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16872 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16873 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016874 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016875 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016876
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016877mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016878 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16879 <packettype>.
16880 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16881 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16882 from.
16883 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16884 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16885 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16886
16887 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16888 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16889 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16890 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16891
16892 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16893 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16894 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16895 packets only):
16896 17: Session Expiry Interval
16897 33: Receive Maximum
16898 39: Maximum Packet Size
16899 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16900 25: Request Response Information
16901 23: Request Problem Information
16902 21: Authentication Method
16903 22: Authentication Data
16904 18: Will Delay Interval
16905 1: Payload Format Indicator
16906 2: Message Expiry Interval
16907 3: Content Type
16908 8: Response Topic
16909 9: Correlation Data
16910 Not supported yet:
16911 38: User Property
16912
16913 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16914 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16915 packets only):
16916 17: Session Expiry Interval
16917 33: Receive Maximum
16918 36: Maximum QoS
16919 37: Retain Available
16920 39: Maximum Packet Size
16921 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16922 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16923 31: Reason String
16924 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16925 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16926 42: Shared Subscription Available
16927 19: Server Keep Alive
16928 26: Response Information
16929 28: Server Reference
16930 21: Authentication Method
16931 22: Authentication Data
16932 Not supported yet:
16933 38: User Property
16934
16935 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16936 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16937 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16938 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16939
16940 Example:
16941
16942 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16943 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16944 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16945 if data_in_buffer
16946 # do the same as above
16947 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16948 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16949 if data_in_buffer
16950
16951mqtt_is_valid
16952 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16953
16954 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16955 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16956 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16957 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16958
16959 Example:
16960
16961 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016962 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016963
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016964mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016965 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016966 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16967 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016968 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016969 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016970 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016971 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16972 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16973 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16974 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016975 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016976 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016977
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016978nbsrv
16979 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16980 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16981 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16982 map lookup.
16983
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016984neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016985 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16986 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16987 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16988 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016989
16990not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016991 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016992 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016993 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016994 absence of a flag).
16995
16996odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016997 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016998 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16999
17000or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017001 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017002 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017003 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
17004 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017005 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017006 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17007 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
17008 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
17009 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017010 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017011 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017012
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017013protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
17014 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
17015 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
17016 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
17017 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
17018 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17019 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17020 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17021 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
17022 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
17023 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17024 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
17025
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010017026regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017027 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
17028 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
17029 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
17030 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
17031 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
17032 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
17033 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
17034 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
17035 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017036 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
17037 of characters with other ones.
17038
17039 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
17040 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
17041 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
17042 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
17043 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
17044 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017045
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017046 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017047
17048 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
17049 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
17050 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010017051 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010017052
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010017053 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
17054 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
17055
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017056 # capture groups and backreferences
17057 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020017058 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010017059 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
17060
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017061capture-req(<id>)
17062 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
17063 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17064
17065 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017066 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17067 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017068
17069capture-res(<id>)
17070 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
17071 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
17072
17073 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020017074 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
17075 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020017076
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020017077rtrim(<chars>)
17078 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
17079 of the input sample.
17080
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017081sdbm([<avalanche>])
17082 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
17083 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17084 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17085 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17086 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17087 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17088 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017089 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
17090 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017091
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017092secure_memcmp(<var>)
17093 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
17094 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
17095 match.
17096
17097 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
17098 performed in constant time.
17099
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017100 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017101 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17102
17103 Example :
17104
17105 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
17106 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
17107 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
17108 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
17109
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017110set-var(<var>[,<cond> ...])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017111 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017112 as-is if all of the specified conditions are true (see below for a list of
17113 possible conditions). The variable keeps the value and the associated input
17114 type. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
17115 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017116 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017117 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17118 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017119 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017120 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17121 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017122 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017123 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017124
Remi Tricot-Le Breton164726c2021-12-16 17:14:40 +010017125 You can pass at most four conditions to the converter among the following
17126 possible conditions :
17127 - "ifexists"/"ifnotexists":
17128 Checks if the variable already existed before the current set-var call.
17129 A variable is usually created through a successful set-var call.
17130 Note that variables of scope "proc" are created during configuration
17131 parsing so the "ifexists" condition will always be true for them.
17132 - "ifempty"/"ifnotempty":
17133 Checks if the input is empty or not.
17134 Scalar types are never empty so the ifempty condition will be false for
17135 them regardless of the input's contents (integers, booleans, IPs ...).
17136 - "ifset"/"ifnotset":
17137 Checks if the variable was previously set or not, or if unset-var was
17138 called on the variable.
17139 A variable that does not exist yet is considered as not set. A "proc"
17140 variable can exist while not being set since they are created during
17141 configuration parsing.
17142 - "ifgt"/"iflt":
17143 Checks if the content of the variable is "greater than" or "less than"
17144 the input. This check can only be performed if both the input and
17145 the variable are of type integer. Otherwise, the check is considered as
17146 true by default.
17147
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017148sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017149 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020017150 sample with length of 20 bytes.
17151
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017152sha2([<bits>])
17153 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
17154 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
17155
17156 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
17157 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
17158
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017159 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020017160 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
17161
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020017162srv_queue
17163 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
17164 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
17165 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
17166 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
17167 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
17168
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017169strcmp(<var>)
17170 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
17171 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
17172 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
17173 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
17174 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
17175 shorter).
17176
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020017177 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
17178 strings in constant time.
17179
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020017180 Example :
17181
17182 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
17183 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
17184 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
17185
17186
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017187sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017188 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
17189 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017190 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017191 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
17192 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017193 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017194 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17195 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017196 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017197 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17198 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017199 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017200 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017201
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017202table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
17203 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17204 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17205 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
17206 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17207 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17208 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
17209
17210
17211table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
17212 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17213 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17214 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
17215 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
17216 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
17217 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
17218
17219table_conn_cnt(<table>)
17220 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17221 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017222 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017223 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
17224 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17225
17226table_conn_cur(<table>)
17227 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17228 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17229 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17230 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17231 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
17232
17233table_conn_rate(<table>)
17234 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17235 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17236 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
17237 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17238 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
17239
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020017240table_gpt(<idx>,<table>)
17241 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17242 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17243 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the general
17244 purpose tag at the index <idx> of the array associated to the input sample
17245 in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17246 If there is no GPT stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17247 This applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on the legacy 'gpt0'
17248 data-type).
17249 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
17250
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017251table_gpt0(<table>)
17252 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17253 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
17254 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17255 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
17256 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
17257
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020017258table_gpc(<idx>,<table>)
17259 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17260 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17261 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the
17262 General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array associated
17263 to the input sample in the designated <table>. <idx> is an integer
17264 between 0 and 99.
17265 If there is no GPC stored at this index, it also returns the boolean value 0.
17266 This applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
17267 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
17268 See also the sc_get_gpc sample fetch keyword.
17269
17270table_gpc_rate(<idx>,<table>)
17271 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a lookup in
17272 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17273 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the Global
17274 Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array (associated to the input sample
17275 in the designated stick-table <table>) was incremented over the
17276 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
17277 If there is no gpc_rate stored at this index, it also returns the boolean
17278 value 0.
17279 This applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to the
17280 legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
17281 See also the sc_gpc_rate sample fetch keyword.
17282
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017283table_gpc0(<table>)
17284 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17285 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17286 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
17287 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17288 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
17289
17290table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
17291 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17292 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17293 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
17294 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17295 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
17296 sample fetch keyword.
17297
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017298table_gpc1(<table>)
17299 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17300 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17301 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
17302 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
17303 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
17304
17305table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
17306 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17307 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17308 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
17309 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
17310 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
17311 sample fetch keyword.
17312
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017313table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
17314 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17315 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017316 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017317 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
17318 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17319
17320table_http_err_rate(<table>)
17321 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17322 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17323 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
17324 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
17325 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
17326 keyword.
17327
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010017328table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
17329 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17330 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17331 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
17332 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17333 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17334
17335table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
17336 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17337 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17338 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
17339 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
17340 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
17341 keyword.
17342
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017343table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
17344 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17345 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017346 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017347 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
17348 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
17349
17350table_http_req_rate(<table>)
17351 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17352 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17353 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
17354 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
17355 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
17356 keyword.
17357
17358table_kbytes_in(<table>)
17359 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17360 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017361 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017362 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17363 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17364 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
17365 keyword.
17366
17367table_kbytes_out(<table>)
17368 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17369 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017370 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017371 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
17372 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
17373 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
17374 keyword.
17375
17376table_server_id(<table>)
17377 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17378 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17379 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17380 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17381 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17382 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17383
17384table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17385 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17386 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017387 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017388 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17389 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17390 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17391 keyword.
17392
17393table_sess_rate(<table>)
17394 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17395 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17396 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17397 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17398 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17399 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17400 keyword.
17401
17402table_trackers(<table>)
17403 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17404 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17405 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17406 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17407 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17408 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17409 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17410 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17411 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17412 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17413
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017414ub64dec
17415 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17416 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17417 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17418
17419 Example:
17420 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17421 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17422
17423ub64enc
17424 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17425
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017426upper
17427 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17428 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17429 type. The result is of type string.
17430
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017431url_dec([<in_form>])
17432 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17433 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17434 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17435 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17436 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17437 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017438
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017439url_enc([<enc_type>])
17440 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17441 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17442 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17443 optional argument is here for future changes.
17444
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017445ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017446 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017447 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17448 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17449 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017450 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17451 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17452 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17453 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017454 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017455 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17456 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017457
17458 Example:
17459 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17460 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17461
17462 message Point {
17463 int32 latitude = 1;
17464 int32 longitude = 2;
17465 }
17466
17467 message PPoint {
17468 Point point = 59;
17469 }
17470
17471 message Rectangle {
17472 // One corner of the rectangle.
17473 PPoint lo = 48;
17474 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17475 PPoint hi = 49;
17476 }
17477
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017478 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17479 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17480 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017481
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017482 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17483 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017484 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017485 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17486
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017487 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017488
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017489 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017490
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017491 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17492 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17493 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017494
17495 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17496 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17497 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17498
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017499 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17500 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17501 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017502
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017503
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017504unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017505 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17506 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17507 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17508 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17509 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17510 response),
17511 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17512 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17513 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17514 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17515
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017516utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17517 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17518 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17519 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17520 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17521 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17522 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17523
17524 Example :
17525
17526 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017527 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017528 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17529
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017530word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17531 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17532 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17533 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017534 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017535 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17536 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17537
17538 Example :
17539 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17540 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17541 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17542 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17543 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017544 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017545
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017546wt6([<avalanche>])
17547 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17548 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17549 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17550 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17551 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17552 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17553 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017554 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17555 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017556
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017557xor(<value>)
17558 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017559 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017560 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017561 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017562 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017563 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17564 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017565 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017566 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17567 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017568 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017569 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017570
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017571xxh3([<seed>])
17572 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17573 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17574 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17575 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17576 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17577 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17578 considered as cryptographically secure.
17579
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017580xxh32([<seed>])
17581 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17582 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17583 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17584 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17585 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17586 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17587 as cryptographically secure.
17588
17589xxh64([<seed>])
17590 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17591 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17592 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17593 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17594 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17595 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17596 as cryptographically secure.
17597
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017598
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200175997.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017600--------------------------------------------
17601
17602A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17603not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17604"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17605The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17606
17607always_false : boolean
17608 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17609 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17610
17611always_true : boolean
17612 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17613 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17614
17615avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017616 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017617 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17618 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17619 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17620 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17621 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17622 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17623 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17624 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17625 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17626 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17627 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17628 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17629 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017631be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017632 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17633 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17634 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17635 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017636 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17637
17638be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17639 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17640 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17641 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17642 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17643 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017644 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17645 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017646
17647 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17648 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17649 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017651be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17652 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17653 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17654 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017655 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017656 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17657 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017658
17659 Example :
17660 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17661 backend dynamic
17662 mode http
17663 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17664 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017665
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017666bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017667 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17668 of the string.
17669
17670bool(<bool>) : bool
17671 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17672 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17673
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017674connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17675 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017676 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017677 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17678 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017679
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017680 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017681 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017682 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17683
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017684 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17685 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017686
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017687 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017688 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017689 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017690 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017691 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017692 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017693 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017694
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017695 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17696 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017697 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017698 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017699
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017700cpu_calls : integer
17701 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17702 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17703 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17704 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17705 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17706 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17707
17708cpu_ns_avg : integer
17709 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17710 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17711 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17712 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17713 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17714 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17715 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17716 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17717 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17718 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17719 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17720
17721cpu_ns_tot : integer
17722 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17723 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17724 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17725 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17726 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17727 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17728 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17729 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17730 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17731 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17732 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17733 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17734 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17735
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017736date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017737 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017738
17739 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17740 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17741 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017742 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17743
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017744 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17745 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17746 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17747 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17748 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17749
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017750 Example :
17751
17752 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17753 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017754
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017755 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17756 # millisecond granularity
17757 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17758
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017759date_us : integer
17760 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17761 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17762 from the same timeval structure.
17763
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017764distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17765 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17766 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17767 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17768 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017769 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017770 list of supported tokens.
17771
17772distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17773 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17774 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17775 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17776 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017777 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017778 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17779 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17780 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17781 supported tokens.
17782
17783 Example :
17784 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17785 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17786 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17787 # send large files to the big farm
17788 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17789
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017790env(<name>) : string
17791 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17792 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17793 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17794 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17795 certain way.
17796
17797 Examples :
17798 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17799 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17800
17801 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
17802 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
17803
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017804fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17805 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017806 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17807 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017808 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17809 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017810 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017811 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17812 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017813
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017814fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17815 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17816 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17817 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17818
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017819fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17820 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17821 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17822 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17823 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17824 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17825 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17826 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17827 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017828
17829 Example :
17830 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17831 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17832 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17833 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17834 frontend mail
17835 bind :25
17836 mode tcp
17837 maxconn 100
17838 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17839 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17840 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17841 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017842
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017843hostname : string
17844 Returns the system hostname.
17845
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017846int(<integer>) : signed integer
17847 Returns a signed integer.
17848
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017849ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17850 Returns an ipv4.
17851
17852ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17853 Returns an ipv6.
17854
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017855lat_ns_avg : integer
17856 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17857 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17858 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17859 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17860 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17861 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17862 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17863 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17864 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017865 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17866 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17867 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17868 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17869 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17870 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017871
17872lat_ns_tot : integer
17873 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17874 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17875 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17876 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17877 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17878 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17879 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17880 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17881 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017882 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17883 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17884 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17885 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17886 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017887 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17888 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17889 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17890 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17891 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17892 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17893
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017894meth(<method>) : method
17895 Returns a method.
17896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017897nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17898 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17899 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17900 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017901 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17902 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17903 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017904
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017905prio_class : integer
17906 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17907 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17908 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17909
17910prio_offset : integer
17911 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17912 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17913 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17914 set-priority-offset".
17915
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017916proc : integer
Willy Tarreaub63dbb72021-06-11 16:50:29 +020017917 Always returns value 1 (historically it would return the calling process
17918 number).
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017919
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017920queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017921 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17922 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17923 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017924 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17925 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17926 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17927 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17928 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17929
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017930rand([<range>]) : integer
17931 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17932 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17933 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17934 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17935 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017937srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17938 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17939 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17940 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17941 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17942 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017943 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17944 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17945
17946srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17947 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17948 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17949 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17950 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17951 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17952 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17953 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17954
17955 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17956 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017957
17958srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17959 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17960 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17961 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017962 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017963 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17964 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17965 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17966
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017967srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17968 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17969 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17970 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17971 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17972 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17973 fetch methods.
17974
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017975srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17976 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17977 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017978 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017979 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17980 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017981 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017982 overloading servers).
17983
17984 Example :
17985 # Redirect to a separate back
17986 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17987 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17988 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17989
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017990srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017991 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17992 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17993 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17994
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017995srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017996 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17997 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17998 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17999
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020018000srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020018001 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
18002 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
18003 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
18004
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010018005stopping : boolean
18006 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
18007 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
18008 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
18009
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020018010str(<string>) : string
18011 Returns a string.
18012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018013table_avl([<table>]) : integer
18014 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
18015 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
18016
18017table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18018 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
18019 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
18020 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
18021
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010018022thread : integer
18023 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
18024 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
18025 and debugging purposes.
18026
Alexandar Lazic528adc32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020018027uuid([<version>]) : string
18028 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
18029 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
18030 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
18031
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018032var(<var-name>[,<default>]) : undefined
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018033 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Willy Tarreau54496a62021-09-03 12:00:13 +020018034 sample fetch fails, unless a default value is provided, in which case it will
18035 return it as a string. Empty strings are permitted. The name of the variable
18036 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010018037 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018038 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
18039 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018040 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010018041 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
18042 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018043 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010018044 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020018045
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200180467.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018047----------------------------------
18048
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018049The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018050closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
18051methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
18052sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
18053TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018054the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
18055counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020018056"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
18057used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
18058can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
18059Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
18060table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
18061tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
18062currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018063
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018064bc_dst : ip
18065 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
18066 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
18067 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
18068 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18069
18070bc_dst_port : integer
18071 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018072 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018073
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018074bc_err : integer
18075 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current backend
18076 connection. See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes
18077 and their corresponding error message.
18078
18079bc_err_str : string
18080 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
18081 backend connection, resulting in a connection failure. See the
18082 "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of error codes and their
18083 corresponding error message.
18084
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010018085bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010018086 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18087 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18088 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
18089
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018090bc_src : ip
18091 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018092 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018093 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18094 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
18095
18096bc_src_port : integer
18097 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018098 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020018099
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018100be_id : integer
18101 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018102 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18103 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018104
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018105be_name : string
18106 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018107 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
18108 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018109
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010018110be_server_timeout : integer
18111 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
18112 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18113 also the "cur_server_timeout".
18114
18115be_tunnel_timeout : integer
18116 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
18117 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
18118 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
18119
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010018120cur_server_timeout : integer
18121 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18122 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
18123 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
18124
18125cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
18126 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
18127 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
18128 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
18129
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018130dst : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018131 This is the destination IP address of the connection on the client side,
18132 which is the address the client connected to. Any tcp/http rules may alter
18133 this address. It can be useful when running in transparent mode. It is of
18134 type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address
18135 is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. When the incoming
18136 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18137 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18138 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18139 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18140 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18141 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018142
18143dst_conn : integer
18144 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
18145 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
18146 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
18147 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
18148 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
18149 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
18150 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
18151 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018152
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018153dst_is_local : boolean
18154 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
18155 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
18156 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
18157 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018158 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018159 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
18160 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
18161 it only once per connection.
18162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018163dst_port : integer
18164 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
18165 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018166 Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. This might be used when running in
18167 transparent mode, when assigning dynamic ports to some clients for a whole
18168 application session, to stick all users to a same server, or to pass the
18169 destination port information to a server using an HTTP header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018170
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018171fc_dst : ip
18172 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18173 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "dst"
18174 for details.
18175
18176fc_dst_is_local : boolean
18177 Returns true if the original destination address of the incoming connection
18178 is local to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the
18179 system. See "dst_is_local" for details.
18180
18181fc_dst_port : integer
18182 Returns an integer value corresponding to the original destination TCP port
18183 of the connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may
18184 alter this address. See "dst-port" for details.
18185
18186fc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018187 Returns the ID of the error that might have occurred on the current
18188 connection. Any strictly positive value of this fetch indicates that the
18189 connection did not succeed and would result in an error log being output (as
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018190 described in section 8.2.6). See the "fc_err_str" fetch for a full list of
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018191 error codes and their corresponding error message.
18192
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010018193fc_err_str : string
Ilya Shipitsin01881082021-08-07 14:41:56 +050018194 Returns an error message describing what problem happened on the current
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018195 connection, resulting in a connection failure. This string corresponds to the
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010018196 "message" part of the error log format (see section 8.2.6). See below for a
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018197 full list of error codes and their corresponding error messages :
18198
18199 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18200 | ID | message |
18201 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18202 | 0 | "Success" |
18203 | 1 | "Reached configured maxconn value" |
18204 | 2 | "Too many sockets on the process" |
18205 | 3 | "Too many sockets on the system" |
18206 | 4 | "Out of system buffers" |
18207 | 5 | "Protocol or address family not supported" |
18208 | 6 | "General socket error" |
18209 | 7 | "Source port range exhausted" |
18210 | 8 | "Can't bind to source address" |
18211 | 9 | "Out of local source ports on the system" |
18212 | 10 | "Local source address already in use" |
18213 | 11 | "Connection closed while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18214 | 12 | "Connection error while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18215 | 13 | "Timeout while waiting for PROXY protocol header" |
18216 | 14 | "Truncated PROXY protocol header received" |
18217 | 15 | "Received something which does not look like a PROXY protocol header" |
18218 | 16 | "Received an invalid PROXY protocol header" |
18219 | 17 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the PROXY protocol header" |
18220 | 18 | "Connection closed while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18221 | 19 | "Connection error while waiting for NetScaler Client IP header" |
18222 | 20 | "Timeout while waiting for a NetScaler Client IP header" |
18223 | 21 | "Truncated NetScaler Client IP header received" |
18224 | 22 | "Received an invalid NetScaler Client IP magic number" |
18225 | 23 | "Received an unhandled protocol in the NetScaler Client IP header" |
18226 | 24 | "Connection closed during SSL handshake" |
18227 | 25 | "Connection error during SSL handshake" |
18228 | 26 | "Timeout during SSL handshake" |
18229 | 27 | "Too many SSL connections" |
18230 | 28 | "Out of memory when initializing an SSL connection" |
18231 | 29 | "Rejected a client-initiated SSL renegotiation attempt" |
18232 | 30 | "SSL client CA chain cannot be verified" |
18233 | 31 | "SSL client certificate not trusted" |
18234 | 32 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the configured one" |
18235 | 33 | "Server presented an SSL certificate different from the expected one" |
18236 | 34 | "SSL handshake failure" |
18237 | 35 | "SSL handshake failure after heartbeat" |
18238 | 36 | "Stopped a TLSv1 heartbeat attack (CVE-2014-0160)" |
18239 | 37 | "Attempt to use SSL on an unknown target (internal error)" |
18240 | 38 | "Server refused early data" |
18241 | 39 | "SOCKS4 Proxy write error during handshake" |
18242 | 40 | "SOCKS4 Proxy read error during handshake" |
18243 | 41 | "SOCKS4 Proxy deny the request" |
18244 | 42 | "SOCKS4 Proxy handshake aborted by server" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton61944f72021-09-29 18:56:51 +020018245 | 43 | "SSL fatal error" |
Remi Tricot-Le Breton3d2093a2021-07-29 09:45:49 +020018246 +----+---------------------------------------------------------------------------+
18247
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018248fc_fackets : integer
18249 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
18250 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18251 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18252 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18253
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020018254fc_http_major : integer
18255 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
18256 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
18257 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
18258
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018259fc_lost : integer
18260 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
18261 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18262 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18263 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18264
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020018265fc_pp_authority : string
18266 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18267 if any.
18268
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010018269fc_pp_unique_id : string
18270 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
18271 if any.
18272
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010018273fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
18274 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
18275 header.
18276
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018277fc_reordering : integer
18278 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
18279 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18280 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18281 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18282
18283fc_retrans : integer
18284 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
18285 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
18286 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
18287 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18288
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020018289fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
18290 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
18291 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
18292 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
18293 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18294 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18295 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18296
18297fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
18298 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
18299 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
18300 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
18301 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
18302 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
18303 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18304
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020018305fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018306 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18307 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18308 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18309 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
18310
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018311fc_src : ip
18312 This is the original destination IP address of the connection on the client
18313 side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter this address. See "src"
18314 for details.
18315
18316fc_src_is_local : boolean
18317 Returns true if the source address of incoming connection is local to the
18318 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system. See
18319 "src_is_local" for details.
18320
18321fc_src_port : integer
18322
18323 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18324 connection on the client side. Only "tcp-request connection" rules may alter
18325 this address. See "src-port" for details.
18326
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018327
Christopher Faulet7bd21922021-10-25 16:18:15 +020018328fc_unacked : integer
18329 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
18330 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
18331 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
18332 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070018333
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020018334fe_defbe : string
18335 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
18336 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
18337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018338fe_id : integer
18339 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010018340 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018341 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18342
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010018343fe_name : string
18344 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
18345 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
18346 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
18347
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010018348fe_client_timeout : integer
18349 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
18350 current frontend.
18351
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018352sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018353sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18354sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18355sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018356 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
18357 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18358 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
18359
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018360sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018361sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18362sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18363sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018364 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
18365 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
18366 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
18367
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018368sc_clr_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18369 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18370 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18371 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18372 returns its previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18373 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18374 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18375 will always return zero.
18376 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18377 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18378
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018379sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018380sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18381sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18382sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018383 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18384 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018385 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18386 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18387 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018388
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018389 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018390 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18391 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018392 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18393 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
18394 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018395 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18396 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18397
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018398sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18399sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18400sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18401sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18402 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
18403 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
18404 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
18405 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
18406 when a first ACL was verified.
18407
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018408sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018409sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18410sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18411sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018412 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018413 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
18414
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018415sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018416sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18417sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
18418sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018419 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18420 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
18421 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
18422
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018423sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018424sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18425sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18426sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018427 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
18428 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
18429 See also src_conn_rate.
18430
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018431sc_get_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18432 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx>
18433 in the GPC array and associated to the currently tracked counter of
18434 ID <ctr> from the current proxy's stick-table or from the designated
18435 stick-table <table>. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18436 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2. If there is not gpc stored at this
18437 index, zero is returned.
18438 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18439 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types). See also src_get_gpc and sc_inc_gpc.
18440
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018441sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018442sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18443sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18444sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018445 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018446 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018447
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018448sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18449sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18450sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18451sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18452 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18453 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18454
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018455sc_get_gpt(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18456 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18457 the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> and from the
18458 current proxy's sitck-table or the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18459 is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18460 If there is no GPT stored at this index, zero is returned.
18461 This fetch applies only to the 'gpt' array data_type (and not on
18462 the legacy 'gpt0' data-type). See also src_get_gpt.
18463
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018464sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18465sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18466sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18467sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18468 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18469 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
18470
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018471sc_gpc_rate(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18472 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18473 index <idx> of the array associated to the tracked counter of ID <ctr> from
18474 the current proxy's table or from the designated stick-table <table>.
18475 It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was incremented over the
18476 configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and <ctr> an integer
18477 between 0 and 2.
18478 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter array must be stored in the stick-table
18479 for a value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18480 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18481 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18482 See also src_gpc_rate, sc_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18483
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018484sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018485sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18486sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
18487sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018488 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
18489 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18490 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018491 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18492 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18493 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018494
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018495sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18496sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18497sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18498sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18499 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18500 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
18501 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18502 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18503 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18504 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18505
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018506sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018507sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18508sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18509sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018510 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018511 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
18512 See also src_http_err_cnt.
18513
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018514sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018515sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18516sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18517sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018518 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
18519 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18520 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
18521 src_http_err_rate.
18522
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018523sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18524sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18525sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18526sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18527 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18528 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18529 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18530
18531sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18532sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18533sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18534sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18535 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18536 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18537 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18538 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18539
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018540sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018541sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18542sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18543sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018544 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018545 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18546 src_http_req_cnt.
18547
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018548sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018549sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18550sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18551sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018552 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18553 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18554 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18555 src_http_req_rate.
18556
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018557sc_inc_gpc(<idx>,<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18558 Increments the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18559 associated to the designated tracked counter of ID <ctr> from current
18560 proxy's stick table or from the designated stick-table <table>, and
18561 returns its new value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99 and
18562 <ctr> an integer between 0 and 2.
18563 Before the first invocation, the stored value is zero, so first invocation
18564 will increase it to 1 and will return 1.
18565 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18566 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18567
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018568sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018569sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18570sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18571sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018572 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018573 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18574 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18575 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18576 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018577
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018578 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018579 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18580 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018581 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18582
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018583sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18584sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18585sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18586sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18587 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18588 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18589 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18590 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18591 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18592
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018593sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018594sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18595sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18596sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018597 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18598 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18599 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018600
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018601sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018602sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18603sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18604sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018605 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18606 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18607 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018608
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018609sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018610sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18611sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18612sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018613 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018614 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18615 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18616 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018617 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018618 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18619
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018620sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018621sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18622sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18623sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018624 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18625 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18626 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18627 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18628 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018629 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018630
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018631sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018632sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18633sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18634sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018635 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18636 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18637 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18638
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018639sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018640sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18641sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18642sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018643 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18644 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018645 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018646 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18647 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018648 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18649 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18650 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018651
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018652so_id : integer
18653 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18654 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18655 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018656
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018657so_name : string
18658 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18659 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18660 strings instead of integers.
18661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018662src : ip
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018663 This is the source IP address of the client of the session. Any tcp/http
18664 rules may alter this address. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and
18665 IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
18666 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the TCP-level source
18667 address which is used, and not the address of a client behind a
18668 proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind directive
18669 is used, it can be the address of a client behind another PROXY-protocol
18670 compatible component for all rule sets except "tcp-request connection" which
18671 sees the real address. When the incoming connection passed through address
18672 translation or redirection involving connection tracking, the original
18673 destination address before the redirection will be reported. On Linux
18674 systems, the source and destination may seldom appear reversed if the
18675 nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late response may reopen a
18676 timed out connection and switch what is believed to be the source and the
18677 destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018678
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018679 Example:
18680 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18681 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18682
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018683src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18684 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18685 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18686 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018687 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018688
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018689src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18690 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18691 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018692 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018693 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018694
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018695src_clr_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18696 Clears the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the array
18697 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18698 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its
18699 previous value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18700 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 0 is returned.
18701 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18702 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18703 See also sc_clr_gpc.
18704
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018705src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18706 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18707 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18708 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18709 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18710 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18711 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018712
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018713 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018714 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18715 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18716 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18717 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018718 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018719 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18720 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18721
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018722src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18723 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18724 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18725 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18726 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18727 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18728 was verified.
18729
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018730src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018731 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018732 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018733 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018734 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018736src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018737 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018738 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18739 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018740 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018741
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018742src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18743 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18744 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18745 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018746 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018747
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018748src_get_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18749 Returns the value of the General Purpose Counter at the index <idx> of the
18750 array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18751 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>. <idx>
18752 is an integer between 0 and 99.
18753 If the address is not found or there is no gpc stored at this index, zero
18754 is returned.
18755 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not on the legacy
18756 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18757 See also sc_get_gpc and src_inc_gpc.
18758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018759src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018760 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018761 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018762 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018763 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018764
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018765src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18766 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18767 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18768 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18769 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18770
Emeric Brun877b0b52021-06-30 18:57:49 +020018771src_get_gpt(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18772 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag at the index <idx> of
18773 the array associated to the incoming connection's source address in the
18774 current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>.
18775 <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18776 If the address is not found or the GPT is not stored, zero is returned.
18777 See also the sc_get_gpt sample fetch keyword.
18778
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018779src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18780 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18781 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18782 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18783 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18784
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018785src_gpc_rate(<idx>[,<table>]) : integer
18786 Returns the average increment rate of the General Purpose Counter at the
18787 index <idx> of the array associated to the incoming connection's
18788 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18789 stick-table <table>. It reports the frequency which the gpc counter was
18790 incremented over the configured period. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18791 Note that the 'gpc_rate' counter must be stored in the stick-table for a
18792 value to be returned, as 'gpc' only holds the event count.
18793 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc_rate' array data_type (and not to
18794 the legacy 'gpc0_rate' nor 'gpc1_rate' data_types).
18795 See also sc_gpc_rate, src_get_gpc, and sc_inc_gpc.
18796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018797src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018798 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018800 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18801 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018802 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18803 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18804 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018805
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018806src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18807 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18808 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18809 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18810 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18811 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18812 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18813 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018815src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018816 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018817 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018818 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018819 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018820 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018822src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18823 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18824 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18825 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18826 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018827 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018828
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018829src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18830 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18831 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018832 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018833 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18834 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18835
18836src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18837 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18838 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18839 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18840 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18841 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18842 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18843
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018844src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018845 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018846 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18847 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018848 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018849
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018850src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18851 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18852 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18853 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018854 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018855 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018856
Emeric Brun4d7ada82021-06-30 19:04:16 +020018857src_inc_gpc(<idx>,[<table>]) : integer
18858 Increments the General Purpose Counter at index <idx> of the array
18859 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18860 stick-table or in the designated stick-table <table>, and returns its new
18861 value. <idx> is an integer between 0 and 99.
18862 If the address is not found, an entry is created and 1 is returned.
18863 This fetch applies only to the 'gpc' array data_type (and not to the legacy
18864 'gpc0' nor 'gpc1' data_types).
18865 See also sc_inc_gpc.
18866
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018867src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18868 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18869 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18870 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018871 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018872 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18873 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018874
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018875 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018876 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018877 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018878 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018879
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018880src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18881 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18882 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18883 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18884 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18885 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18886 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18887
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018888src_is_local : boolean
18889 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18890 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18891 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18892 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018893 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018894 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18895 once per connection.
18896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018897src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018898 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18899 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18900 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18901 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18902 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018904src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018905 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18906 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18907 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18908 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18909 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018910
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018911src_port : integer
18912 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Christopher Faulet888cd702021-10-25 16:58:50 +020018913 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected
18914 from. Any tcp/http rules may alter this address. Usage of this function is
18915 very limited as modern protocols do not care much about source ports
18916 nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018918src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018919 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018920 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18921 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18922 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018923 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018924
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018925src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18926 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18927 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18928 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18929 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018930 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018932src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18933 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18934 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18935 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18936 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18937 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18938 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18939 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18940 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018941
18942 Example :
18943 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18944 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18945 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18946 listen ssh
18947 bind :22
18948 mode tcp
18949 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018950 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018951 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018952 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018954srv_id : integer
18955 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18956 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018957 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018958
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018959srv_name : string
18960 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18961 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018962 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018963
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189647.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018965----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018966
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018967The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018968closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18969when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18970usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018971future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018972
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001897351d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18974 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18975 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18976 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18977 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18978 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18979
18980 Example :
18981 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18982 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18983 # the request.
18984 frontend http-in
18985 bind *:8081
18986 default_backend servers
18987 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18988 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18989
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018990ssl_bc : boolean
18991 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18992 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018993 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18994 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018995
18996ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18997 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018998 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18999 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019000
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019001ssl_bc_alpn : string
19002 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
19003 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019004 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019005 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19006 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19007 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
19008 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
19009 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019010 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
19011 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019012
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019013ssl_bc_cipher : string
19014 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019015 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19016 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019017
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019018ssl_bc_client_random : binary
19019 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19020 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19021 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019022 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019023
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019024ssl_bc_err : integer
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019025 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019026 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19027 backend side. It can raise handshake errors as well as other read or write
19028 errors occurring during the connection's lifetime. In order to get a text
19029 description of this error code, you can either use the "ssl_bc_err_str"
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019030 sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which takes an error code
19031 in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer to your SSL
19032 library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error codes.
19033
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019034ssl_bc_err_str : string
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019035 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019036 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19037 that was raised on the connection from the backend's perspective. See also
19038 "ssl_fc_err".
Remi Tricot-Le Breton163cdeb2021-09-01 15:52:14 +020019039
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019040ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
19041 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19042 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019043 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19044 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010019045
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019046ssl_bc_npn : string
19047 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
19048 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020019049 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019050 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
19051 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
19052 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
19053 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019054 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
19055 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010019056
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019057ssl_bc_protocol : string
19058 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019059 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
19060 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019061
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019062ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019063 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019064 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019065 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
19066 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019067
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019068ssl_bc_server_random : binary
19069 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
19070 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19071 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019072 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019073
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019074ssl_bc_session_id : binary
19075 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
19076 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019077 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
19078 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019079
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019080ssl_bc_session_key : binary
19081 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
19082 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19083 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019084 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019085
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019086ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
19087 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020019088 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
19089 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020019090
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019091ssl_c_ca_err : integer
19092 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19093 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
19094 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
19095 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
19096 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020019097
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019098ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
19099 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19100 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
19101 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
19102 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019103
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019104ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019105 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
19106 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19107 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019108 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019109 does not support resumed sessions.
19110
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010019111ssl_c_der : binary
19112 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
19113 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19114 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019116ssl_c_err : integer
19117 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19118 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
19119 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
19120 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19121 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019122
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019123ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019124 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19125 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19126 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19127 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19128 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19129 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19130 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19131 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019132 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19133 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19134 LDAP v3.
19135 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19136 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019137
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019138ssl_c_key_alg : string
19139 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19140 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19141 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019142
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019143ssl_c_notafter : string
19144 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
19145 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19146 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020019147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019148ssl_c_notbefore : string
19149 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
19150 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19151 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019152
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019153ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019154 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19155 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19156 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19157 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19158 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19159 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19160 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19161 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019162 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19163 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19164 LDAP v3.
19165 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19166 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010019167
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019168ssl_c_serial : binary
19169 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
19170 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19171 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019172
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019173ssl_c_sha1 : binary
19174 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
19175 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
19176 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019177 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
19178 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
19179
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019180 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020019181 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019183ssl_c_sig_alg : string
19184 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19185 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19186 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019188ssl_c_used : boolean
19189 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
19190 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019191
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019192ssl_c_verify : integer
19193 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
19194 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
19195 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
19196 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019198ssl_c_version : integer
19199 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
19200 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019201
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010019202ssl_f_der : binary
19203 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
19204 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19205 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19206
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019207ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019208 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19209 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19210 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19211 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019212 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019213 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19214 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19215 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019216 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19217 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19218 LDAP v3.
19219 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19220 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019221
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019222ssl_f_key_alg : string
19223 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19224 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
19225 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019226
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019227ssl_f_notafter : string
19228 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19229 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19230 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019231
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019232ssl_f_notbefore : string
19233 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
19234 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19235 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019236
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019237ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019238 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19239 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19240 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19241 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19242 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19243 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
19244 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19245 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050019246 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19247 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19248 LDAP v3.
19249 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19250 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020019251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019252ssl_f_serial : binary
19253 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19254 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19255 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020019256
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020019257ssl_f_sha1 : binary
19258 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
19259 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19260 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19261
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019262ssl_f_sig_alg : string
19263 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19264 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19265 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020019266
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019267ssl_f_version : integer
19268 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
19269 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19270
19271ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019272 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
19273 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
19274 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
19275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019276 Example :
19277 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
19278 listen http-https
19279 bind :80
19280 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
19281 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
19282
19283ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
19284 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
19285 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
19286
19287ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019288 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019289 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019290 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019291 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
19292 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
19293 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
19294 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
19295 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
19296 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
19297
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019298ssl_fc_cipher : string
19299 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
19300 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020019301
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019302ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19303 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
19304 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019305 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019306 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19307 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19308 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019309
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019310 Example:
19311 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19312 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19313 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19314 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19315 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19316 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19317 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19318 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19319 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19320
19321ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019322 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019323 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019324 capture buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
19325 Setting <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019326 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19327 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019328
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019329ssl_fc_cipherlist_str([<filter_option>]) : string
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019330 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019331 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019332 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019333 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19334 0 : return the full list of ciphers (default)
19335 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19336 Note that this sample-fetch is only available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the
19337 function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash like
19338 "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019339
19340ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019341 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can return only if the value
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019342 "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash take
19343 into account all the data of the cipher list.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019344
19345ssl_fc_ecformats_bin : binary
19346 Return the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curve point
19347 formats. The maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019348 buffer size controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019349
19350 Example:
19351 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19352 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19353 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19354 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19355 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19356 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19357 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19358 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19359 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19360
19361ssl_fc_eclist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19362 Returns the binary form of the client hello supported elliptic curves. The
19363 maximum returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019364 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019365 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19366 0 : return the full list of supported elliptic curves (default)
19367 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19368
19369 Example:
19370 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19371 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19372 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19373 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19374 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19375 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19376 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19377 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19378 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19379
19380ssl_fc_extlist_bin([<filter_option>]) : binary
19381 Returns the binary form of the client hello extension list. The maximum
19382 returned value length is limited by the shared capture buffer size
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019383 controlled by "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" setting. Setting
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019384 <filter_option> allows to filter returned data. Accepted values:
19385 0 : return the full list of extensions (default)
19386 1 : exclude GREASE (RFC8701) values from the output
19387
19388 Example:
19389 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19390 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19391 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19392 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19393 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19394 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19395 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19396 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19397 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010019398
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019399ssl_fc_client_random : binary
19400 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19401 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19402 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19403
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019404ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
19405 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19406 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19407 transport layer.
19408 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19409 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19410 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19411 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19412
19413ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19414 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19415 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19416 transport layer.
19417 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19418 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19419 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19420 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19421
19422ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
19423 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19424 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19425 transport layer.
19426 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19427 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19428 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19429 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19430
19431ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
19432 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19433 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19434 transport layer.
19435 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19436 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19437 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19438 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19439
19440ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
19441 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19442 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19443 transport layer.
19444 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19445 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19446 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19447 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19448
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020019449ssl_fc_err : integer
19450 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19451 returns the ID of the last error of the first error stack raised on the
19452 frontend side, or 0 if no error was encountered. It can be used to identify
19453 handshake related errors other than verify ones (such as cipher mismatch), as
19454 well as other read or write errors occurring during the connection's
19455 lifetime. Any error happening during the client's certificate verification
19456 process will not be raised through this fetch but via the existing
19457 "ssl_c_err", "ssl_c_ca_err" and "ssl_c_ca_err_depth" fetches. In order to get
19458 a text description of this error code, you can either use the
19459 "ssl_fc_err_str" sample fetch or use the "openssl errstr" command (which
19460 takes an error code in hexadecimal representation as parameter). Please refer
19461 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
19462 codes.
19463
19464ssl_fc_err_str : string
19465 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19466 returns a string representation of the last error of the first error stack
19467 that was raised on the frontend side. Any error happening during the client's
19468 certificate verification process will not be raised through this fetch. See
19469 also "ssl_fc_err".
19470
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019471ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019472 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
19473 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010019474 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
19475 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
19476 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
19477 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020019478
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020019479ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
19480 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
19481 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
19482 wait until the handshake happened.
19483
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019484ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
19485 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019486 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
19487 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019488 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020019489 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019490
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020019491ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019492 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010019493 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
19494 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020019495
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019496ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019497 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019498 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019499 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
19500 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
19501 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
19502 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
19503 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
19504 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020019505
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019506ssl_fc_protocol : string
19507 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
19508 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019509
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019510ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id : integer
19511 The version of the TLS protocol by which the client wishes to communicate
19512 during the session as indicated in client hello message. This value can
Marcin Deranek310a2602021-07-13 19:04:24 +020019513 return only if the value "tune.ssl.capture-buffer-size" is set greater than
19514 0.
Marcin Deranek959a48c2021-07-13 15:14:21 +020019515
19516 Example:
19517 http-request set-header X-SSL-JA3 %[ssl_fc_protocol_hello_id],\
19518 %[ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19519 %[ssl_fc_extlist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19520 %[ssl_fc_eclist_bin(1),be2dec(-,2)],\
19521 %[ssl_fc_ecformats_bin,be2dec(-,1)]
19522 acl is_malware req.fhdr(x-ssl-ja3),digest(md5),hex \
19523 -f /path/to/file/with/malware-ja3.lst
19524 http-request set-header X-Malware True if is_malware
19525 http-request set-header X-Malware False if !is_malware
19526
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019527ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019528 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020019529 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Faulet15ae22c2021-11-09 14:23:36 +010019530 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040019531
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020019532ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
19533 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
19534 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
19535 transport layer.
19536 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19537 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19538 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19539 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19540
19541ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
19542 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
19543 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
19544 transport layer.
19545 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
19546 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
19547 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
19548 "tune.ssl.keylog"
19549
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040019550ssl_fc_server_random : binary
19551 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
19552 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
19553 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
19554
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019555ssl_fc_session_id : binary
19556 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
19557 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
19558 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
19559 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020019560
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040019561ssl_fc_session_key : binary
19562 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
19563 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
19564 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
19565 BoringSSL.
19566
19567
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019568ssl_fc_sni : string
19569 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
19570 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019571 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019572 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
19573 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
19574
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019575 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019576 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019577 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050019578 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020019579 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019581 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019582 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
19583 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020019584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019585ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
19586 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
19587 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019588
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019589ssl_s_der : binary
19590 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
19591 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19592 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19593
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019594ssl_s_chain_der : binary
19595 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
19596 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19597 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050019598 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020019599 does not support resumed sessions.
19600
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019601ssl_s_key_alg : string
19602 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
19603 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
19604 SSL/TLS transport layer.
19605
19606ssl_s_notafter : string
19607 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
19608 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19609 transport layer.
19610
19611ssl_s_notbefore : string
19612 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
19613 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
19614 transport layer.
19615
19616ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19617 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19618 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
19619 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19620 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19621 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19622 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019623 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19624 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019625 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19626 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19627 LDAP v3.
19628 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19629 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19630
19631ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
19632 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
19633 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
19634 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
19635 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
19636 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
19637 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020019638 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
19639 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020019640 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
19641 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
19642 LDAP v3.
19643 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
19644 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
19645
19646ssl_s_serial : binary
19647 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
19648 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
19649 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
19650
19651ssl_s_sha1 : binary
19652 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
19653 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
19654 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
19655
19656ssl_s_sig_alg : string
19657 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
19658 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
19659 layer.
19660
19661ssl_s_version : integer
19662 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
19663 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019664
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200196657.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019666------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020019667
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019668Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
19669sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
19670only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
19671For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
19672be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
19673can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
19674sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
19675for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
19676content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020019677
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019678Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
19679 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019680 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010019681 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
19682 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
19683 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
19684 sample expression). So be careful.
19685
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019686payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019687 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019688 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
19689 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019691payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
19692 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019693 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019694 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010019695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019696req.len : integer
19697req_len : integer (deprecated)
19698 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19699 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19700 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19701 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19702 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019703 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019704 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
19705 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019706
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019707req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19708 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019709 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
19710 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
19711 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
19712 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019714 ACL alternatives :
19715 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019716
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019717req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19718 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19719 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19720 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19721 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019722
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019723 ACL alternatives :
19724 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019725
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019726 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019728req.proto_http : boolean
19729req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19730 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19731 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19732 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19733 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19734 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19735 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19736 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019737
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019738 Example:
19739 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19740 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19741 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019742 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019744req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19745rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19746 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19747 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19748 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19749 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19750 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19751 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19752 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019753
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019754 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19755 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19756 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19757 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19758 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19759 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019760
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019761 ACL derivatives :
19762 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019763
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019764 Example :
19765 listen tse-farm
19766 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19767 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19768 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19769 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19770 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19771 persist rdp-cookie
19772 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19773 # This is only useful makes sense if
19774 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19775 stick-table type string size 204800
19776 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19777 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19778 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019779
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019780 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
19781 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019783req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19784rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19785 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19786 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19787 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19788 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019789
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019790 ACL derivatives :
19791 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019792
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019793req.ssl_alpn : string
19794 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19795 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19796 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19797 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19798 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19799 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019800 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019801
19802 Examples :
19803 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19804 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19805 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019806 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019807 default_backend bk_default
19808
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019809req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19810 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19811 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019812 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19813 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19814 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19815 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19816 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019817
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019818req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19819req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19820 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19821 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19822 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19823 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19824 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19825 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19826 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019828req.ssl_sni : string
19829req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19830 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19831 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19832 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19833 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19834 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019835 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19836 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19837 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19838 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19839 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19840 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19841 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19842 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19843 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019845 ACL derivatives :
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019846 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019847
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019848 Examples :
19849 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19850 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19851 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex5c866202021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019852 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019853 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019854
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019855req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19856 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19857 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19858 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19859 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19860 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19861 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19862 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19863 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19864 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19865
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019866req.ssl_ver : integer
19867req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19868 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19869 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19870 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19871 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19872 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19873 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19874 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019875 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019876 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019877
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019878 ACL derivatives :
19879 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019880
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019881res.len : integer
19882 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19883 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19884 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19885 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19886 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019887 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019888 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019889 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019890
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019891res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19892 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019893 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019894 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019895 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019896 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019897
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019898res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19899 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19900 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19901 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019902 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19903 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019904
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019905 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019906
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019907res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19908rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19909 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19910 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19911 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19912 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19913 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19914 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19915 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019917wait_end : boolean
19918 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19919 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019920 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019921 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19922 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019923 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019924 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19925 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019926
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019927 Examples :
19928 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19929 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19930 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019931
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019932 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19933 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19934 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19935 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19936 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19937 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19938 tcp-request content reject
19939
19940
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200199417.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019942--------------------------------------
19943
19944It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19945This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19946data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19947its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19948HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19949content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19950to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19951more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19952response are indexed.
19953
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019954Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19955 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19956 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19957 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19958 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19959 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19960 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19961
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019962base : string
19963 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19964 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19965 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19966 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19967 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19968 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19969 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19970 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19971
19972 ACL derivatives :
19973 base : exact string match
19974 base_beg : prefix match
19975 base_dir : subdir match
19976 base_dom : domain match
19977 base_end : suffix match
19978 base_len : length match
19979 base_reg : regex match
19980 base_sub : substring match
19981
19982base32 : integer
19983 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19984 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19985 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019986 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19987 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19988 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019989
19990base32+src : binary
19991 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19992 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19993 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19994 per-URL counters.
19995
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019996baseq : string
19997 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19998 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19999 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
20000 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
20001
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020002capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
20003 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
20004 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20005 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
20006
20007capture.req.method : string
20008 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
20009 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
20010 because it's allocated.
20011
20012capture.req.uri : string
20013 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
20014 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
20015 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
20016 allocated.
20017
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020018capture.req.ver : string
20019 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20020 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
20021 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
20022
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010020023capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
20024 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
20025 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
20026 The first entry is an index of 0.
20027 See also: "capture response header"
20028
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020020029capture.res.ver : string
20030 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
20031 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
20032 persistent flag.
20033
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020034req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020035 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
20036 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
20037 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020038
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020020039req.body_param([<name>) : string
20040 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
20041 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
20042 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
20043 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
20044 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
20045 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
20046 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
20047 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
20048 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
20049 given.
20050
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020051req.body_len : integer
20052 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
20053 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020054 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
20055 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020056
20057req.body_size : integer
20058 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020020059 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20060 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020020061
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020062req.cook([<name>]) : string
20063cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20064 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20065 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
20066 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
20067 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
20068 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
20069 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
20070 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
20071 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
20072
20073 ACL derivatives :
20074 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
20075 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
20076 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
20077 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
20078 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
20079 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
20080 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
20081 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020082
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020083req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20084cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20085 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20086 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020087
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020088req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20089cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20090 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20091 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
20092 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
20093 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020094
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020095cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20096 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
20097 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
20098 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
20099 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020100 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020101 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
20102 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
20103 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
20104 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020105
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020106hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20107 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
20108 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
20109 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
20110 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020111 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020112
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020113req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020114 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
20115 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
20116 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
20117 with headers such as User-Agent.
20118
20119 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20120 found.
20121
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020122 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20123 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20124 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020125 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020126
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020127req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20128 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20129 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020130 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
20131 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020132
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020133req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020134 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
20135 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
20136 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
20137 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
20138 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
20139 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
20140 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
20141
20142 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
20143 found.
20144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020145 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
20146 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
20147 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020148 with -1 being the last one.
20149
20150 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
20151 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020152
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020153 ACL derivatives :
20154 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20155 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20156 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20157 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20158 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20159 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20160 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20161 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20162
20163req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20164hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
20165 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
20166 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020167 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
20168 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
20169 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
20170
20171 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
20172 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
20173 which contain more than one of certain headers.
20174
20175 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020176
20177req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20178hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
20179 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
20180 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
20181 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010020182 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
20183 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
20184 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
20185 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
20186 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020187
20188 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20189
20190 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020191
20192req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20193hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
20194 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
20195 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
20196 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020197
20198 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
20199
20200 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020201
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020202req.hdrs : string
20203 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
20204 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20205 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
20206 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20207
20208req.hdrs_bin : binary
20209 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20210 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
20211 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
20212 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
20213 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
20214 names and values (length of 0 for both).
20215
20216 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020217
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010020218 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20219 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010020220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020221http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
20222 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
20223 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
20224 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20225 basic auth is supported.
20226
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonf5dd3372021-10-01 15:36:53 +020020227http_auth_bearer([<header>]) : string
20228 Returns the client-provided token found in the authorization data when the
20229 Bearer scheme is used (to send JSON Web Tokens for instance). No check is
20230 performed on the data sent by the client.
20231 If a specific <header> is supplied, it will parse this header instead of the
20232 Authorization one.
20233
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020234http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
20235 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
20236 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
20237 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
20238 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020239 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
20240 basic auth is supported.
20241
20242 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010020243 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
20244 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
20245 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
20246 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020247
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020248http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020249 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
20250 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20251 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020252
20253http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020254 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
20255 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
20256 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020257
20258http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010020259 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
20260 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
20261 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020020262
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020263http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020264 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
20265 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020266 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
20267 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020020268
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020269method : integer + string
20270 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
20271 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
20272 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
20273 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
20274 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
20275 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
20276 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020277
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020278 ACL derivatives :
20279 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020281 Example :
20282 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
20283 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
20284 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020286path : string
20287 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
20288 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
20289 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
20290 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
20291 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020292 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020293 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020294
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020295 ACL derivatives :
20296 path : exact string match
20297 path_beg : prefix match
20298 path_dir : subdir match
20299 path_dom : domain match
20300 path_end : suffix match
20301 path_len : length match
20302 path_reg : regex match
20303 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020304
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020020305pathq : string
20306 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
20307 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
20308 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
20309 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
20310 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
20311 result in both cases.
20312
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020313query : string
20314 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
20315 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
20316 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
20317 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010020318 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010020319 which stops before the question mark.
20320
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020321req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20322 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20323 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20324 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
20325 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20326
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020327req.ver : string
20328req_ver : string (deprecated)
20329 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
20330 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
20331 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020332
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020333 ACL derivatives :
20334 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020335
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020336res.body : binary
20337 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
20338 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020339 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20340
20341 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020342
20343res.body_len : integer
20344 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
20345 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020346 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20347
20348 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020349
20350res.body_size : integer
20351 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
20352 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
20353 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
20354 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020355 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
20356
20357 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020358
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010020359res.cache_hit : boolean
20360 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
20361 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
20362
20363res.cache_name : string
20364 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
20365 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
20366 empty string.
20367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020368res.comp : boolean
20369 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
20370 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
20371 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020373res.comp_algo : string
20374 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
20375 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
20376 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020378res.cook([<name>]) : string
20379scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20380 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20381 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020382 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20383
20384 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020386 ACL derivatives :
20387 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020020388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020389res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20390scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20391 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
20392 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020393 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
20394
20395 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020396
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020397res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
20398scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
20399 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20400 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020401 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
20402
20403 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010020404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020405res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020406 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20407 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20408
20409 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
20410 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
20411
20412 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
20413
20414 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020416res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020417 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20418 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20419
20420 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
20421 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
20422
20423 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020424
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020425res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
20426shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020427 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
20428 on the headers within an HTTP response.
20429
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020430 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020431 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
20432
20433 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020434
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020435 ACL derivatives :
20436 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
20437 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
20438 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
20439 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
20440 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
20441 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
20442 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
20443 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
20444
20445res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
20446shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020447 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
20448 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20449
20450 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050020451 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020452
20453 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020454
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020455res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
20456shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020457 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
20458 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20459
20460 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20461
20462 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020020463
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020464res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
20465 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
20466 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
20467 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020468 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
20469
20470 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010020471
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020472res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
20473shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020474 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
20475 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
20476
20477 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
20478
20479 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020480
20481res.hdrs : string
20482 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
20483 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
20484 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020485 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
20486
20487 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020020488
20489res.hdrs_bin : binary
20490 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
20491 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
20492 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
20493 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
20494 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
20495 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
20496 (length of 0 for both).
20497
20498 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
20499
20500 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
20501 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020502
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020503res.ver : string
20504resp_ver : string (deprecated)
20505 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020506 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
20507
20508 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020020509
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020510 ACL derivatives :
20511 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010020512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020513set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
20514 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
20515 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020020516 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020517 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020518
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020519 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
20520 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010020521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020522status : integer
20523 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
20524 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010020525 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
20526
20527 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020528
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020020529unique-id : string
20530 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
20531 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
20532 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
20533 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
20534 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
20535 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
20536
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020537url : string
20538 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
20539 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
20540 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
20541 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
20542 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
20543 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
20544 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020546 ACL derivatives :
20547 url : exact string match
20548 url_beg : prefix match
20549 url_dir : subdir match
20550 url_dom : domain match
20551 url_end : suffix match
20552 url_len : length match
20553 url_reg : regex match
20554 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020555
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020556url_ip : ip
20557 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
20558 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
20559 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
20560 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020561 entry in a table for a given source address. It may be used in combination
20562 with 'http-request set-dst' to emulate the older 'option http_proxy'.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020564url_port : integer
20565 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
Willy Tarreau25241232021-07-18 19:18:56 +020020566 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed..
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020567
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020568urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
20569url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020570 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
20571 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020572 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
20573 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
20574 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
20575 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020576 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
20577 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020020578 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
20579 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020580
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020581 ACL derivatives :
20582 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
20583 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
20584 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
20585 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
20586 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
20587 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
20588 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
20589 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020590
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020591
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020592 Example :
20593 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
20594 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
20595 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
20596 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020020597
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030020598urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020020599 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
20600 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
20601 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020020602
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020020603url32 : integer
20604 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
20605 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
20606 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
20607 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
20608 is an unsigned integer.
20609
20610url32+src : binary
20611 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
20612 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
20613 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
20614
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020020615
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200206167.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020617---------------------------------------
20618
20619This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
20620used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
20621purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
20622There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
20623or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
20624any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
20625for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
20626
20627internal.htx.data : integer
20628 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
20629 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20630
20631internal.htx.free : integer
20632 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
20633 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20634
20635internal.htx.free_data : integer
20636 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
20637 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20638
20639internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010020640 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
20641 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
20642 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020643
20644internal.htx.nbblks : integer
20645 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
20646 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20647
20648internal.htx.size : integer
20649 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
20650 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20651
20652internal.htx.used : integer
20653 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
20654 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20655 direction.
20656
20657internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
20658 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20659 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
20660 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
20661 of the special value :
20662 * head : The oldest inserted block
20663 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020664 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020665
20666internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
20667 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20668 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
20669 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
20670 integer or one of the special value :
20671 * head : The oldest inserted block
20672 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020673 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020674
20675internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
20676 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
20677 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
20678 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
20679 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20680
20681 * head : The oldest inserted block
20682 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020683 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020684
20685internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
20686 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20687 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20688 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20689 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20690
20691 * head : The oldest inserted block
20692 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020693 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020694
20695internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
20696 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
20697 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
20698 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20699 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20700
20701 * head : The oldest inserted block
20702 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020703 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020704
20705internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
20706 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
20707 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
20708 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
20709 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
20710
20711 * head : The oldest inserted block
20712 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050020713 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010020714
20715internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
20716 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
20717 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
20718 it returns false.
20719
20720
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200207217.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020722---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020723
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020724Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20725every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020726order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020727
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020728ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020729---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20730FALSE always_false never match
20731HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20732HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20733HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020734HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020735HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20736HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20737HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20738HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
Björn Jacke20d0f502021-10-15 16:32:15 +020020739LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 ::1 match connection from local host
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020740METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20741METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20742METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20743METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20744METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20745METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20746METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20747METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20748RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20749REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20750TRUE always_true always match
20751WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20752---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020753
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020754
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207558. Logging
20756----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020757
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020758One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20759provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20760very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20761provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20762state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020763to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020764headers.
20765
20766In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20767about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20768send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20769
20770 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20771 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20772 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20773 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20774 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020775 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020776 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020777
20778The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20779allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20780as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20781while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20782real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20783delay.
20784
20785
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207868.1. Log levels
20787---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020789TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020790source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020791HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20792in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20793track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20794syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20795about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020796
20797
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207988.2. Log formats
20799----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020800
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020801HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020802and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20803slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20804options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020805
20806 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20807 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20808 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20809 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20810 extents.
20811
20812 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20813 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20814 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20815 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20816 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20817
20818 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20819 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20820 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20821 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20822 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20823
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020824 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20825 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20826 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20827 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20828
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020829 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20830
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020831Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20832specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20833field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20834servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20835always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20836identifier.
20837
20838Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20839 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20840 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20841 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20842 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20843
20844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208458.2.1. Default log format
20846-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020847
20848This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20849as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20850format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20851
20852 Example :
20853 listen www
20854 mode http
20855 log global
20856 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20857
20858 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20859 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20860 (www/HTTP)
20861
20862 Field Format Extract from the example above
20863 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20864 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20865 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20866 4 'to' to
20867 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20868 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20869
20870Detailed fields description :
20871 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20872 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20873 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20874 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20875 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20876 and processed the connection.
20877 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20878
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020879In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20880"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20881connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20882
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020883It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20884will eventually disappear.
20885
20886
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208878.2.2. TCP log format
20888---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020889
20890The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20891is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20892information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20893counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20894emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20895environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20896the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20897sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020898specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010020899not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
20900
20901The TCP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
20902exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010020903if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010020904
20905 # strict equivalent of "option tcplog"
20906 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20907 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
20908
20909A few fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those
20910are marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020911
20912 Example :
20913 frontend fnt
20914 mode tcp
20915 option tcplog
20916 log global
20917 default_backend bck
20918
20919 backend bck
20920 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20921
20922 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20923 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20924 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20925
20926 Field Format Extract from the example above
20927 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20928 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20929 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20930 4 frontend_name fnt
20931 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20932 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20933 7 bytes_read* 212
20934 8 termination_state --
20935 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20936 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20937
20938Detailed fields description :
20939 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020940 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020941 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20942 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020943 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020944 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020945 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020946
20947 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020948 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20949 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20950 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020951
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020952 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020953 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20954 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020955 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20956 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20957 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20958 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020959
20960 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20961 and processed the connection.
20962
20963 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20964 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20965 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20966 applications.
20967
20968 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20969 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20970 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20971 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20972 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20973
20974 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20975 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20976 See "Timers" below for more details.
20977
20978 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20979 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20980 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20981 "Timers" below for more details.
20982
20983 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020984 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020985 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20986 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20987 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20988 details.
20989
20990 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20991 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20992 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20993 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20994 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20995
20996 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20997 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20998 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20999 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
21000 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
21001 for more details.
21002
21003 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021004 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021005 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
21006 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
21007 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021008 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021009
21010 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21011 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21012 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21013 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21014 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21015 caused by a denial of service attack.
21016
21017 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21018 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21019 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21020 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21021 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21022 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21023 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21024 denial of service attack.
21025
21026 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21027 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21028 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21029 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21030 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21031 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21032 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21033 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
21034 be processed than on other servers.
21035
21036 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21037 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21038 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21039 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021040 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021041 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21042 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21043 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21044 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21045 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21046 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21047 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21048 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21049
21050 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21051 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21052 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21053 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21054 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21055 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021056 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021057 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21058
21059 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21060 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21061 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21062 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21063 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21064 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021065 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021066 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21067 occurs.
21068
21069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210708.2.3. HTTP log format
21071----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021072
21073The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
21074is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
21075the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
21076are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
21077emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
21078generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
21079"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
21080which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021081frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
21082is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021083
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021084The HTTP log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21085exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021086if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021087
21088 # strict equivalent of "option httplog"
21089 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21090 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
21091
21092And the CLF log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on
21093this exact string:
21094
21095 # strict equivalent of "option httplog clf"
21096 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
21097 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
21098 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
21099
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021100Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
21101slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
21102with a star ('*') after the field name below.
21103
21104 Example :
21105 frontend http-in
21106 mode http
21107 option httplog
21108 log global
21109 default_backend bck
21110
21111 backend static
21112 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
21113
21114 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21115 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
21116 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021117 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021118
21119 Field Format Extract from the example above
21120 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21121 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021122 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021123 4 frontend_name http-in
21124 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021125 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021126 7 status_code 200
21127 8 bytes_read* 2750
21128 9 captured_request_cookie -
21129 10 captured_response_cookie -
21130 11 termination_state ----
21131 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21132 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21133 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21134 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21135 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021136
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021137Detailed fields description :
21138 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021139 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021140 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
21141 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021142 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021143 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010021144 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021145
21146 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010021147 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
21148 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
21149 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021150
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021151 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021152 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021153
21154 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
21155 and processed the connection.
21156
21157 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
21158 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
21159 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
21160
21161 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
21162 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
21163 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
21164 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
21165 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
21166 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
21167
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021168 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
21169 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
21170 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021171 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021172 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
21173 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021174 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021175 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021176
21177 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
21178 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021179 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021180
21181 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
21182 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021183 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
21184 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021185
21186 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
21187 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
21188 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
21189 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
21190 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021191 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
21192 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021193
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021194 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021195 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
21196 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
21197 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
21198 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
21199 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
21200 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021201 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021202
21203 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021204 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
21205 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021206
21207 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
21208 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021209 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021210 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
21211 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
21212 overflowing.
21213
21214 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
21215 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
21216 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
21217 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
21218 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
21219 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
21220 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
21221 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21222
21223 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
21224 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
21225 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
21226 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
21227 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
21228 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
21229 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
21230 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
21231
21232 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
21233 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
21234 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
21235 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
21236 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
21237 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
21238 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
21239
21240 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021241 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021242 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
21243 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
21244 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021245 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021246 system.
21247
21248 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
21249 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
21250 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
21251 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
21252 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
21253 caused by a denial of service attack.
21254
21255 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
21256 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
21257 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
21258 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
21259 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
21260 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
21261 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
21262 denial of service attack.
21263
21264 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
21265 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
21266 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
21267 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
21268 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
21269 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
21270 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
21271 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
21272 processed than on other servers.
21273
21274 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
21275 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
21276 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
21277 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021278 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021279 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
21280 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
21281 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
21282 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
21283 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
21284 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
21285 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
21286 should not be attributed to the logged server.
21287
21288 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21289 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
21290 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
21291 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
21292 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
21293 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021294 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021295 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
21296
21297 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
21298 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
21299 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
21300 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
21301 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
21302 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021303 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021304 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
21305 occurs.
21306
21307 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
21308 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
21309 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
21310 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
21311 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
21312 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
21313 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
21314 cookies" below for more details.
21315
21316 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
21317 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
21318 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
21319 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
21320 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
21321 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
21322 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
21323 and cookies" below for more details.
21324
21325 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
21326 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
21327 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
21328 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
21329 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
21330 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
21331 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
21332 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
21333
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021334
213358.2.4. HTTPS log format
21336----------------------
21337
21338The HTTPS format is the best suited for HTTP over SSL connections. It is an
21339extension of the HTTP format (see section 8.2.3) to which SSL related
21340information are added. It is enabled when "option httpslog" is specified in the
21341frontend. Just like the TCP and HTTP formats, the log is usually emitted at the
21342end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified. A session which
21343matches the "monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log
21344sessions for which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option
21345dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if
21346"option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend.
21347
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021348The HTTPS log format is internally declared as a custom log format based on the
21349exact following string, which may also be used as a basis to extend the format
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021350if required. Refer to section 8.2.6 "Custom log format" to see how to use this:
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021351
21352 # strict equivalent of "option httpslog"
21353 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
21354 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r \
21355 %[fc_err]/%[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/\
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021356 %[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021357
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021358This format is basically the HTTP one (see section 8.2.3) with new fields
21359appended to it. The new fields (lines 17 and 18) will be detailed here. For the
21360HTTP ones, refer to the HTTP section.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021361
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021362 Example :
21363 frontend https-in
21364 mode http
21365 option httpslog
21366 log global
21367 bind *:443 ssl crt mycerts/srv.pem ...
21368 default_backend bck
21369
21370 backend static
21371 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000 ssl crt mycerts/clt.pem ...
21372
21373 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
21374 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] https-in \
21375 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021376 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1" 0/0/0/0/0 \
21377 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021378
21379 Field Format Extract from the example above
21380 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
21381 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
21382 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
21383 4 frontend_name https-in
21384 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
21385 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
21386 7 status_code 200
21387 8 bytes_read* 2750
21388 9 captured_request_cookie -
21389 10 captured_response_cookie -
21390 11 termination_state ----
21391 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
21392 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
21393 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
21394 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
21395 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021396 17 fc_err '/' ssl_fc_err '/' ssl_c_err
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021397 '/' ssl_c_ca_err '/' ssl_fc_is_resumed 0/0/0/0/0
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021398 18 ssl_fc_sni '/' ssl_version
21399 '/' ssl_ciphers 1wt.eu/TLSv1.3/TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021400
21401Detailed fields description :
Willy Tarreau6f749762021-11-05 17:07:03 +010021402 - "fc_err" is the status of the connection on the frontend's side. It
21403 corresponds to the "fc_err" sample fetch. See the "fc_err" and "fc_err_str"
21404 sample fetch functions for more information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021405
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021406 - "ssl_fc_err" is the last error of the first SSL error stack that was
21407 raised on the connection from the frontend's perspective. It might be used
21408 to detect SSL handshake errors for instance. It will be 0 if everything
Ilya Shipitsinbd6b4be2021-10-15 16:18:21 +050021409 went well. See the "ssl_fc_err" sample fetch's description for more
Remi Tricot-Le Breton1fe0fad2021-09-29 18:56:52 +020021410 information.
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021411
21412 - "ssl_c_err" is the status of the client's certificate verification process.
21413 The handshake might be successful while having a non-null verification
21414 error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_err" sample fetch and
21415 the "crt-ignore-err" option.
21416
21417 - "ssl_c_ca_err" is the status of the client's certificate chain verification
21418 process. The handshake might be successful while having a non-null
21419 verification error code if it is an ignored one. See the "ssl_c_ca_err"
21420 sample fetch and the "ca-ignore-err" option.
21421
William Lallemand1d58b012021-10-14 14:27:48 +020021422 - "ssl_fc_is_resumed" is true if the incoming TLS session was resumed with
21423 the stateful cache or a stateless ticket. Don't forgot that a TLS session
21424 can be shared by multiple requests.
21425
Willy Tarreau68574dd2021-11-05 19:14:55 +010021426 - "ssl_fc_sni" is the SNI (Server Name Indication) presented by the client
21427 to select the certificate to be used. It usually matches the host name for
21428 the first request of a connection. An absence of this field may indicate
21429 that the SNI was not sent by the client, and will lead haproxy to use the
21430 default certificate, or to reject the connection in case of strict-sni.
21431
Remi Tricot-Le Breton98b930d2021-07-29 09:45:52 +020021432 - "ssl_version" is the SSL version of the frontend.
21433
21434 - "ssl_ciphers" is the SSL cipher used for the connection.
21435
21436
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +0100214378.2.5. Error log format
21438-----------------------
21439
21440When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
21441protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format,
21442unless a dedicated error log format is defined through an "error-log-format"
21443line. By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
21444"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
21445will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
21446logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
21447
21448The default format looks like this :
21449
21450 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
21451 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
21452 Connection error during SSL handshake
21453
21454 Field Format Extract from the example above
21455 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
21456 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
21457 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
21458 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
21459 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
21460
21461These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
21462failures.
21463
21464By using the "error-log-format" directive, the legacy log format described
21465above will not be used anymore, and all error log lines will follow the
21466defined format.
21467
21468An example of reasonably complete error-log-format follows, it will report the
21469source address and port, the connection accept() date, the frontend name, the
21470number of active connections on the process and on thit frontend, haproxy's
21471internal error identifier on the front connection, the hexadecimal OpenSSL
21472error number (that can be copy-pasted to "openssl errstr" for full decoding),
21473the client certificate extraction status (0 indicates no error), the client
21474certificate validation status using the CA (0 indicates no error), a boolean
21475indicating if the connection is new or was resumed, the optional server name
21476indication (SNI) provided by the client, the SSL version name and the SSL
21477ciphers used on the connection, if any. Note that backend connection errors
21478are never reported here since in order for a backend connection to fail, it
21479would have passed through a successful stream, hence will be available as
21480regular traffic log (see option httplog or option httpslog).
21481
21482 # detailed frontend connection error log
Lukas Tribus2b949732021-12-09 01:27:14 +010021483 error-log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %ac/%fc %[fc_err]/\
Willy Tarreauec5c1102021-11-06 09:18:33 +010021484 %[ssl_fc_err,hex]/%[ssl_c_err]/%[ssl_c_ca_err]/%[ssl_fc_is_resumed] \
21485 %[ssl_fc_sni]/%sslv/%sslc"
21486
21487
214888.2.6. Custom log format
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021489------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021490
Willy Tarreau2ed73502021-11-05 18:09:06 +010021491When the default log formats are not sufficient, it is possible to define new
21492ones in very fine details. As creating a log-format from scratch is not always
21493a trivial task, it is strongly recommended to first have a look at the existing
21494formats ("option tcplog", "option httplog", "option httpslog"), pick the one
21495looking the closest to the expectation, copy its "log-format" equivalent string
21496and adjust it.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021497
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021498HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021499Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
21500separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
21501prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
21502
21503Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
21504variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021505("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021506
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021507If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020021508as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010021509less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
21510the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
21511
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020021512Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
21513"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
21514delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
21515preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021516
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021517Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
21518'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
21519https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
21520such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
21521
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021522Flags are :
21523 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021524 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021525 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
21526 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021527
21528 Example:
21529
21530 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
21531 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
21532
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010021533 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
21534
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021535Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
21536
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021537 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021538 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021539 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
21540 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
21541 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021542 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
21543 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
21544 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021545 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021546 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000021547 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000021548 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000021549 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000021550 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
21551 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010021552 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020021553 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021554 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3010e002021-12-03 10:48:36 +010021555 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021556 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020021557 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080021558 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021559 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
21560 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
21561 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
21562 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
21563 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021564 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021565 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021566 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021567 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021568 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021569 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
21570 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021571 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21572 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
21573 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021574 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021575 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
21576 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021577 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021578 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
21579 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
21580 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020021581 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020021582 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021583 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
21584 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
21585 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
21586 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020021587 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020021588 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021589 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021590 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010021591 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021592 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021593 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
21594 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
21595 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021596 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021597 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
21598 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010021599 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021600 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
21601 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020021602 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021603 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021604 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010021605 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021606
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020021607 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010021608
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010021609
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216108.3. Advanced logging options
21611-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021612
21613Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
21614just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
21615options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
21616for more information about their usage.
21617
21618
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216198.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
21620------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021621
21622It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021623HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021624commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
21625monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
21626ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
21627
21628 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
21629 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
21630 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
21631 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
21632
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020021633 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
21634 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021635
21636 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
21637 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
21638 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
21639
21640
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216418.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
21642----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021643
21644The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
21645what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
21646or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021647"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021648just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
21649log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
21650after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
21651is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
21652with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
21653with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
21654
21655
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216568.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
21657------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021658
21659Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
21660for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
21661"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
21662retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
21663raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
21664a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
21665file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
21666you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
21667"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
21668
21669
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216708.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
21671--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020021672
21673Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
21674multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
21675them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
21676"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
21677logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
21678error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
21679and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
21680too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
21681useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
21682alternative.
21683
21684
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200216858.4. Timing events
21686------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021687
21688Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
21689reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
21690the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
21691frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021692mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
21693addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
21694
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021695Timings events in HTTP mode:
21696
21697 first request 2nd request
21698 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
21699 t tr t tr ...
21700 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
21701 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
21702 :<---- Tq ---->: :
21703 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021704 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010021705 :<--------- Ta --------->:
21706
21707Timings events in TCP mode:
21708
21709 TCP session
21710 |<----------------->|
21711 t t
21712 ---|----|----|----|----|---
21713 | Th Tw Tc Td |
21714 |<------ Tt ------->|
21715
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021716 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021717 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021718 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
21719 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
21720 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021721 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021722 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
21723 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
21724 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
21725 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021726
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021727 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
21728 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
21729 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020021730 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
21731 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
21732 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
21733 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
21734 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
21735 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021736
21737 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
21738 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
21739 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
21740 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
21741 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
21742 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
21743 request typed by hand during a test.
21744
21745 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
21746 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021747 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021748 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
21749 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
21750 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
21751 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021752
21753 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
21754 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
21755 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
21756 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
21757 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
21758
21759 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
21760 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
21761 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
21762 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
21763 connection never established.
21764
21765 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
21766 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
21767 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
21768 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
21769 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
21770 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
21771 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
21772 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
21773 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
21774 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
21775 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
21776
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021777 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
21778 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
21779 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
21780 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
21781 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
21782 by subtracting other timers when valid :
21783
21784 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
21785
21786 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
21787 "Ta" can never be negative.
21788
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021789 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
21790 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021791 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
21792 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021793 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021794
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021795 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021796
21797 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021798 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
21799 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021800
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000021801 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
21802 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
21803 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
21804 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
21805 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
21806 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
21807 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
21808 prefixed with a '+' sign.
21809
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021810These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
21811protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
21812that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021813due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
21814"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
21815that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021816
21817Most common cases :
21818
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021819 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
21820 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
21821 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
21822 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
21823 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021824 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021825 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
21826 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
21827 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
21828 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
21829 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020021830 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021831
21832 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
21833 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
21834 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
21835 of ms on remote networks.
21836
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021837 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
21838 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
21839 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021840
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021841 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
21842 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021843 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021844 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
21845 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
21846 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
21847 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
21848 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
21849 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021850
21851Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
21852
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021853 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021854 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021855 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021856
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021857 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021858 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
21859 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21860
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021861 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021862 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21863 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21864 flags.
21865
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021866 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21867 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021868 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21869 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21870 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21871 the client connection was maintained open.
21872
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021873 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021874 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021875 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021876 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21877
21878
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200218798.5. Session state at disconnection
21880-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021881
21882TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21883"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
218842-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21885each of which has a special meaning :
21886
21887 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21888 session to terminate :
21889
21890 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21891
21892 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21893 server explicitly refused it.
21894
21895 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21896 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21897 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21898 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021899 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021900
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021901 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021902 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021903
21904 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21905 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21906 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21907 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21908 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21909
21910 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21911 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21912 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21913 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21914 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21915
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021916 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021917 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21918
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021919 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021920 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21921 backup connections when going up.
21922
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021923 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021924
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021925 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21926 send or receive data.
21927
21928 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21929 send or receive data.
21930
21931 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21932 with nothing left in the buffers.
21933
21934 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21935
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021936 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021937 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21938
21939 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21940 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21941 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21942 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21943 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21944
21945 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21946 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21947
21948 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21949 server (HTTP only).
21950
21951 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21952
21953 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21954 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21955 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21956
21957 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21958 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21959 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21960
21961 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21962
21963 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21964 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21965
21966 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21967 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21968 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21969
21970 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21971 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021972 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21973 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021974
21975 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21976 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21977 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21978 another server.
21979
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021980 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021981 server.
21982
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021983 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21984 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21985 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21986 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21987
21988 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21989 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21990 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21991 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21992
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021993 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21994 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21995 "use-server" rule).
21996
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021997 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21998
21999 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
22000 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
22001
22002 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
22003
22004 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
22005 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
22006 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
22007
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022008 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
22009 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030022010 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022011 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
22012 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
22013
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022014 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
22015
22016 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
22017 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
22018
22019 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
22020
22021 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
22022
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022023The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
22024was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022025helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
22026starvation, attacks, etc...
22027
22028The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
22029alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
22030easier finding and understanding.
22031
22032 Flags Reason
22033
22034 -- Normal termination.
22035
22036 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022037 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
22038 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022039 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
22040
22041 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
22042 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022043 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
22044 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022045 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
22046 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022047
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022048 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22049 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022050 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022051
22052 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
22053 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
22054 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
22055
22056 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
22057 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
22058 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
22059 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
22060 the server takes too long to respond.
22061
22062 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
22063 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
22064 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
22065 long a time to respond.
22066
22067 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
22068 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
22069 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022070 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022071 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
22072 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022073
22074 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
22075 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
22076 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
22077 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
22078 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020022079 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022080 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
22081 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
22082 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
22083 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
22084 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
22085 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
22086 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
22087 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022088 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020022089 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
22090 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
22091 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022092
22093 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
22094 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020022095 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
22096 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
22097 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
22098 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022099
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022100 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020022101 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
22102
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022103 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022104 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
22105 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022106 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022107 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
22108 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
22109
22110 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
22111 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
22112 503 or 504 here.
22113
22114 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022115 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022116 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
22117 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
22118 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
22119
22120 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
22121 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022122 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022123 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022124 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022125
22126 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
22127 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
22128 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
22129 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
22130 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
22131 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022132 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022133
22134 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
22135 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
22136 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
22137 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
22138 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
22139 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
22140 solution is to fix the application.
22141
22142 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
22143 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
22144 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
22145 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
22146 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
22147 external attacks.
22148
22149 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070022150 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020022151 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022152 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
22153 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
22154
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022155 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
22156 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
22157 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022158 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020022159 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022161 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
22162 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
22163 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
22164 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010022165 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
22166 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
22167 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
22168 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
22169 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022170
22171 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
22172 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
22173 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
22174 returned an HTTP 403 error.
22175
22176 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
22177 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
22178 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
22179 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
22180
22181 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
22182 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
22183 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
22184 only be solved by proper system tuning.
22185
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022186The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022187persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022188important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
22189re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
22190
22191 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
22192
22193 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22194 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
22195 set on a GET request.
22196
22197 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
22198 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040022199 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020022200 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
22201
22202 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
22203 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
22204 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
22205
22206 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
22207 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
22208 already got a cookie.
22209
22210 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22211 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
22212 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
22213 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
22214 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
22215
22216 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
22217 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22218 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22219
22220 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
22221 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
22222 new cookie was inserted in the response.
22223
22224 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
22225 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
22226
22227 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
22228 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
22229 then advertised in the response.
22230
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022231
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222328.6. Non-printable characters
22233-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022234
22235In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
22236consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
22237converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
22238prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
22239being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
22240escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
22241is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
22242'}' when logging headers.
22243
22244Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
22245issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
22246containing spaces is "User-Agent".
22247
22248Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
22249the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
22250performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
22251
22252
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222538.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
22254---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022255
22256Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
22257achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022258section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022259cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
22260the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
22261the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022262locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022263not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
22264user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
22265a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
22266wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
22267
22268 Examples :
22269 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
22270 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
22271
22272 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
22273 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
22274
22275
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200222768.8. Capturing HTTP headers
22277---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022278
22279Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
22280proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
22281the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
22282server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
22283
22284Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
22285response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022286section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022287
22288It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022289time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
22290appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022291are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
22292and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
22293follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
22294request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
22295in the logs.
22296
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020022297As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
22298frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
22299an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
22300
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022301 Example :
22302 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
22303 listen proxy-out
22304 mode http
22305 option httplog
22306 option logasap
22307 log global
22308 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
22309
22310 # log the name of the virtual server
22311 capture request header Host len 20
22312
22313 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
22314 capture request header Content-Length len 10
22315
22316 # log the beginning of the referrer
22317 capture request header Referer len 20
22318
22319 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
22320 capture response header Server len 20
22321
22322 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
22323 capture response header Content-Length len 10
22324
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022325 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022326 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
22327
22328 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
22329 capture response header Via len 20
22330
22331 # log the URL location during a redirection
22332 capture response header Location len 20
22333
22334 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
22335 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
22336 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22337 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
22338 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
22339
22340 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22341 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22342 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22343 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022344 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022345
22346 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
22347 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
22348 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
22349 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
22350 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022351 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022352
22353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200223548.9. Examples of logs
22355---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022356
22357These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
22358them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
22359reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
22360
22361 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
22362 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22363 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22364
22365 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
22366 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
22367
22368 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
22369 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
22370 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
22371
22372 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
22373 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
22374
22375 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
22376 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
22377 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
22378
22379 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010022380 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022381 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
22382 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
22383
22384 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
22385 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
22386 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
22387
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022388 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
22389 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
22390 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
22391 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022392 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020022393 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022394
22395 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022396 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022397
22398 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
22399 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
22400 Nothing was sent to any server.
22401
22402 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
22403 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
22404
22405 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
22406 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022407 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022408 send a 408 return code to the client.
22409
22410 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
22411 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
22412
22413 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
22414 5 seconds ("c----").
22415
22416 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
22417 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010022418 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022419
22420 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020022421 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010022422 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
22423 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
22424 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
22425 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
22426 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010022427
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020022428
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200224299. Supported filters
22430--------------------
22431
22432Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
22433accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
22434unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
22435
22436See also : "filter"
22437
224389.1. Trace
22439----------
22440
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010022441filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022442
22443 Arguments:
22444 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
22445 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
22446
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010022447 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022448
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022449 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022450 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
22451 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
22452 amount of the parsed data.
22453
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022454 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010022455
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022456This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
22457callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
22458information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
22459filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
22460
22461Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
22462tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
22463a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
22464
22465
224669.2. HTTP compression
22467---------------------
22468
22469filter compression
22470
22471The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
22472keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022473when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
22474fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
22475done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
22476explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
22477filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
22478listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22479order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022480
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022481See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
22482 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020022483
22484
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200224859.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
22486--------------------------------------------
22487
22488filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
22489
22490 Arguments :
22491
22492 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
22493 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
22494 parsed.
22495
22496 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
22497 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
22498 part must be placed in its own scope.
22499
22500The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
22501external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010022502streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022503exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
22504also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
22505
22506SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
22507the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
22508
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010022509For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020022510"doc/SPOE.txt".
22511
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100225129.4. Cache
22513----------
22514
22515filter cache <name>
22516
22517 Arguments :
22518
22519 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
22520
22521The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
22522"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050022523cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022524other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
22525case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
22526is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
22527filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010022528listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22529order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010022530
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022531See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
22532 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
22533
22534
225359.5. Fcgi-app
22536-------------
22537
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022538filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022539
22540 Arguments :
22541
22542 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
22543
22544The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
22545request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
22546reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
22547used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
22548implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
22549used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
22550fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
22551used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
22552order.
22553
22554See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
22555 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
22556
22557
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100225589.6. OpenTracing
22559----------------
22560
22561The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
22562HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
22563of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
22564Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
22565
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040022566This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022567
22568The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
22569HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
22570participates in the work of HAProxy.
22571
22572filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
22573
22574 Arguments :
22575
22576 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
22577 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
22578 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
22579 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
22580 OpenTracing filters.
22581
22582 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
22583 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
22584 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
22585 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
22586 filter must have its own scope defined.
22587
22588More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020022589of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010022590
22591
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002259210. FastCGI applications
22593-------------------------
22594
22595HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
22596feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
22597the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
22598FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
22599servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
22600FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
22601backend.
22602
22603HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
22604application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
22605connection.
22606
2260710.1. Setup
22608-----------
22609
2261010.1.1. Fcgi-app section
22611--------------------------
22612
22613fcgi-app <name>
22614 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
22615 document root must be defined.
22616
22617acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
22618 Declare or complete an access list.
22619
22620 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
22621 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
22622 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
22623 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
22624 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
22625
22626docroot <path>
22627 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
22628 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
22629 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
22630
22631index <script-name>
22632 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
22633 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
22634 is an optional setting.
22635
22636 Example :
22637 index index.php
22638
22639log-stderr global
22640log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010022641 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022642 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
22643
22644 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
22645 default STDERR messages are ignored.
22646
22647pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22648 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
22649 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
22650 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22651
22652 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
22653 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
22654 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
22655 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
22656
22657 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
22658 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
22659
22660path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022661 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022662 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
22663 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
22664 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
22665 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
22666 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
22667 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
22668 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022669
22670 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022671 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010022672 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
22673 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
22674 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
22675 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022676
22677 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010022678 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
22679 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022680
22681option get-values
22682no option get-values
22683 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
22684
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040022685 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022686 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
22687
22688 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
22689 application will accept.
22690
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020022691 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
22692 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022693
22694 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050022695 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022696 option is disabled.
22697
22698 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
22699 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
22700 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
22701 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
22702 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
22703 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
22704
22705option keep-conn
22706no option keep-conn
22707 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
22708 sending a response.
22709
22710 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
22711 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
22712
22713option max-reqs <reqs>
22714 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
22715 accept.
22716
22717 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
22718 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
22719 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
22720 to 1.
22721
22722option mpxs-conns
22723no option mpxs-conns
22724 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
22725
22726 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
22727 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
22728
22729set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
22730 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
22731 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
22732 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
22733 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
22734
22735 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
22736 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
22737 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
22738
22739 Example :
22740 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
22741 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
22742
22743 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
22744
22745
2274610.1.2. Proxy section
22747---------------------
22748
22749use-fcgi-app <name>
22750 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
22751
22752 Arguments :
22753 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
22754
22755 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
22756 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
22757 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
22758 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
22759 application may be defined at a time per backend.
22760
22761 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
22762 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
22763 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
22764 application are evaluated.
22765
22766
2276710.1.3. Example
22768---------------
22769
22770 frontend front-http
22771 mode http
22772 bind *:80
22773 bind *:
22774
22775 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
22776 default_backend back-static
22777
22778 backend back-static
22779 mode http
22780 server www A.B.C.D:80
22781
22782 backend back-dynamic
22783 mode http
22784 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
22785 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
22786
22787 fcgi-app php-fpm
22788 log-stderr global
22789 option keep-conn
22790
22791 docroot /var/www/my-app
22792 index index.php
22793 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
22794
22795
2279610.2. Default parameters
22797------------------------
22798
22799A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
22800the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050022801script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022802applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
22803
22804 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22805 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
22806 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
22807 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
22808 | | |
22809 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22810 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
22811 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
22812 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
22813 | | application. |
22814 | | |
22815 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22816 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
22817 | | the request. It may not be set. |
22818 | | |
22819 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22820 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
22821 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
22822 | | the application's configuration. |
22823 | | |
22824 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22825 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
22826 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
22827 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
22828 | | |
22829 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22830 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
22831 | | following the part that identifies the script |
22832 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
22833 | | be defined. |
22834 | | |
22835 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22836 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
22837 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
22838 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
22839 | | is not set too. |
22840 | | |
22841 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22842 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
22843 | | set. |
22844 | | |
22845 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22846 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
22847 | | the request. |
22848 | | |
22849 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22850 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
22851 | | client as part of user authentication. |
22852 | | |
22853 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22854 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22855 | | script to process the request. |
22856 | | |
22857 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22858 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22859 | | |
22860 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22861 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22862 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22863 | | |
22864 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22865 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22866 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22867 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22868 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22869 | | |
22870 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22871 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22872 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22873 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22874 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22875 | | side. |
22876 | | |
22877 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22878 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22879 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22880 | | connected to. |
22881 | | |
22882 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22883 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22884 | | |
22885 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Faulet5cd0e522021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022886 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22887 | | current HAProxy version. |
22888 | | |
22889 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022890 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22891 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22892 | | |
22893 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22894
22895
2289610.3. Limitations
22897------------------
22898
22899The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22900way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22901during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22902establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22903application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22904or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22905message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22906these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22907and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22908
22909Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22910request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22911requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22912
22913About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22914into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22915fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22916"http-request" ones.
22917
22918Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22919FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22920processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22921must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22922here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022923
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022924
2292511. Address formats
22926-------------------
22927
22928Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22929address.
22930
22931This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22932The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22933of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22934equivalent is '::'.
22935
22936Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22937is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22938
22939This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22940family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22941
22942Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22943configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22944use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22945'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22946
22947Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22948socket type and the transport method.
22949
22950
2295111.1 Address family prefixes
22952----------------------------
22953
22954'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22955
22956'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22957 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22958 listening.
22959
22960'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22961 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22962 on the statement using this address, a port or
22963 a port range may or must be specified.
22964
22965'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22966 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22967 using this address, a port or a port range
22968 may or must be specified.
22969
22970'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22971 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22972 using this address, a port or a port range
22973 may or must be specified.
22974
22975'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22976 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22977 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22978 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22979 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22980 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22981
22982'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22983 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22984 start by slash '/'.
22985
22986
2298711.2 Socket type prefixes
22988-------------------------
22989
22990Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22991type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22992this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22993This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22994but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22995
22996Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22997instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22998
22999If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
23000they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
23001report this to the maintainers.
23002
23003'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23004 to "stream"
23005
23006'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
23007 to "datagram".
23008
23009
2301011.3 Protocol prefixes
23011----------------------
23012
23013'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23014 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23015 socket type and transport method is forced to
23016 "stream". Depending on the statement using
23017 this address, a port or a port range can or
23018 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23019 of 'stream+ip@'.
23020
23021'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23022 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23023 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23024 statement using this address, a port or port
23025 range can or must be specified.
23026 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23027
23028'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23029 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23030 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
23031 statement using this address, a port or port
23032 range can or must be specified.
23033 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23034
23035'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
23036 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
23037 socket type and transport method is forced to
23038 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
23039 this address, a port or a port range can or
23040 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
23041 of 'dgram+ip@'.
23042
23043'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23044 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
23045 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23046 the statement using this address, a port or
23047 port range can or must be specified.
23048 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23049
23050'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
23051 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
23052 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
23053 the statement using this address, a port or
23054 port range can or must be specified.
23055 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
23056
23057'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23058 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
23059 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
23060
23061'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
23062 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
23063 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
23064
23065In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
23066QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
23067
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010023068/*
23069 * Local variables:
23070 * fill-column: 79
23071 * End:
23072 */